blob: 3d019e91f821479e3fbc1500f788fb15a7a18e55 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufe3f1912014-10-18 17:48:02 +02005 version 1.5.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufe3f1912014-10-18 17:48:02 +02007 2014/10/18
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
660ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
662 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100664 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
665 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
666 information.
667
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100668ssl-server-verify [none|required]
669 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
670 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
671 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
672
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200673stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
674 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
675 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
676 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
677 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200678
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200679 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
680 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
681 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200682
683stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
684 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
685 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100686 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200687
688stats maxconn <connections>
689 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
690 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692uid <number>
693 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
694 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
695 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
696 one. See also "gid" and "user".
697
698ulimit-n <number>
699 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
700 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
701 option.
702
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100703unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
704 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
705
706 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
707 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
708 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
709 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
710 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
711 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
712 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
713 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
714 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
715 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717user <user name>
718 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
719 See also "uid" and "group".
720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200721node <name>
722 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
723
724 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
725 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
726 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
727 traffic.
728
729description <text>
730 Add a text that describes the instance.
731
732 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
733 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
734 "<" and ">" characters.
735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007373.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738-----------------------
739
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200740max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
741 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
742 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
743 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
744 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
745 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
746 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
747 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
748 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750maxconn <number>
751 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
752 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
753 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200754 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
755 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
756 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
757 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
758 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200760maxconnrate <number>
761 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
762 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
763 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
764 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
765 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
766 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
767 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
768 fairness.
769
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100770maxcomprate <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300772 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100773 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
774 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
775 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
776 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
777 default value.
778
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100779maxcompcpuusage <number>
780 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
781 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
782 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
783 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
784 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
785 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
786 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
787 process down and from introducing high latencies.
788
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100789maxpipes <number>
790 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
791 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
792 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
793 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
794 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
795 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
796
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200797maxsessrate <number>
798 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
799 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
800 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
801 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
802 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
803 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
804 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
805 fairness.
806
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200807maxsslconn <number>
808 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
809 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
810 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
811 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
812 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
813 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
814 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
815
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200816maxsslrate <number>
817 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
818 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
819 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
820 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
821 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
822 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
823 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
824 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
825 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
826 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
827
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100828maxzlibmem <number>
829 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
830 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
831 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100832 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
833 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
834 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
835
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836noepoll
837 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
838 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100839 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840
841nokqueue
842 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
843 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
844 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
845
846nopoll
847 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
848 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100849 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100850 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100852nosplice
853 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
854 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
855 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100856 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100857 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
858 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
859 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
860 "option splice-response".
861
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300862nogetaddrinfo
863 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
864 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
865
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200866spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900867 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
868 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
869 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
870 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
871 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
872 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200873
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200874tune.bufsize <number>
875 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
876 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
877 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
878 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
879 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
880 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
881 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
882 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400883 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
884 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
885 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200886
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200887tune.chksize <number>
888 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
889 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
890 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
891 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
892 checks whenever possible.
893
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100894tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
895 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
896 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
897 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
898 this value. The default value is 1.
899
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100900tune.http.cookielen <number>
901 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
902 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
903 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
904 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
905 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
906 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
907 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
908 to change this value.
909
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200910tune.http.maxhdr <number>
911 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
912 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
913 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
914 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
915 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
916 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
917 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
918 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
919 limit too high.
920
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100921tune.idletimer <timeout>
922 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
923 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
924 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
925 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
926 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
927 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
928 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
929 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
930 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
931
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100932tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100933 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
934 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
935 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
936 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
937 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
938 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
939 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
940 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
941 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
942 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100943
944tune.maxpollevents <number>
945 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
946 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
947 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
948 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
949 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
950
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200951tune.maxrewrite <number>
952 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
953 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
954 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
955 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
956 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
957 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
958 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
959 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
960 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
961 bufsize.
962
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200963tune.pipesize <number>
964 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
965 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
966 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
967 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
968 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
969 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
970
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100971tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
972tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
973 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
974 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
975 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
976 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
977 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
978 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
979 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
980
981tune.sndbuf.client <number>
982tune.sndbuf.server <number>
983 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
984 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
985 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
986 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
987 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
988 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
989 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
990 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
991 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
992 notifying haproxy again.
993
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100994tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100995 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
996 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
997 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300998 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100999 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1000 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1001 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1002 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1003 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001004 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1005 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001006
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001007tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1008 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1009 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1010 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1011 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1012 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1013 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1014
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001015tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1016 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001017 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001018 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1019 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1020 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1021 being used for too long.
1022
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001023tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1024 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1025 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1026 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1027 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1028 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1029 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1030 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1031 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1032 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1033 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001034 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1035 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001036
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001037tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1038 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1039 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1040 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1041 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1042 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1043 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1044 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1045 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1046
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001047tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1048 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001049 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001050 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1051 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1052 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1053
1054tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1055 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1056 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1057 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1058 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010603.3. Debugging
1061--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062
1063debug
1064 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1065 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1066 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1067 system startup.
1068
1069quiet
1070 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1071 line argument "-q".
1072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010743.4. Userlists
1075--------------
1076It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1077http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1078it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1079
1080userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001081 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001082 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1083
1084group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001085 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001086 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1087 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1088
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001089user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1090 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001091 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1092 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001093 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1094 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001095 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001096 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097
1098
1099 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001100 userlist L1
1101 group G1 users tiger,scott
1102 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001103
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001104 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1105 user scott insecure-password elgato
1106 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001107
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001108 userlist L2
1109 group G1
1110 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001112 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1113 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1114 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001115
1116 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001117
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001118
11193.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001120----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001121It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1122haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1123pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1124identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1125or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1126Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1127known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1128the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1129process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1130during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1131tables.
1132
1133peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001134 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1136
1137peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1138 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1139 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1140 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1141 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1142 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1143 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1144
1145 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1146 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1147
1148 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1149 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1150 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1151 across all peers.
1152
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001153 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1154 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1155 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1156
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001157 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001158 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001159 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1160 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1161 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001162
1163 backend mybackend
1164 mode tcp
1165 balance roundrobin
1166 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1167 stick on src
1168
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001169 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1170 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001171
1172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011734. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001174----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1177 - defaults <name>
1178 - frontend <name>
1179 - backend <name>
1180 - listen <name>
1181
1182A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1183its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1184section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001185section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001186
1187A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1188connections.
1189
1190A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1191to forward incoming connections.
1192
1193A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1194parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001196All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1197'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1198case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1199
1200Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1201logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1202proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1203However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1204name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1205
1206Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1207and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001208bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1210modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1211arbitrary criteria.
1212
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001213In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1214a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1215the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1216
1217 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1218 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1219 between responses and new requests.
1220
1221 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1222 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1223 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1224 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1225
1226 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1227 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1228 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1229
1230 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1231 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1232 client-facing connection remains open.
1233
1234 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1235 after the end of the response.
1236
1237The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1238frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1239following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1240weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1241
1242 Backend mode
1243
1244 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1245 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1246 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1247 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1248 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1249 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1250 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1251 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1252 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1253 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1254 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001256
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1259--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001261The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1262limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1263they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1264limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001265marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001266option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001267and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1268with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1269specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001271
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1273------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1274acl - X X X
1275appsession - - X X
1276backlog X X X -
1277balance X - X X
1278bind - X X -
1279bind-process X X X X
1280block - X X X
1281capture cookie - X X -
1282capture request header - X X -
1283capture response header - X X -
1284clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001285compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1287cookie X - X X
1288default-server X - X X
1289default_backend X X X -
1290description - X X X
1291disabled X X X X
1292dispatch - - X X
1293enabled X X X X
1294errorfile X X X X
1295errorloc X X X X
1296errorloc302 X X X X
1297-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1298errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001299force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300fullconn X - X X
1301grace X X X X
1302hash-type X - X X
1303http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001304http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001305http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001307http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001308http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001309id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001310ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001311log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001312max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001313maxconn X X X -
1314mode X X X X
1315monitor fail - X X -
1316monitor-net X X X -
1317monitor-uri X X X -
1318option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1319option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1320option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1321option allbackups (*) X - X X
1322option checkcache (*) X - X X
1323option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1324option contstats (*) X X X -
1325option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1326option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1327option forceclose (*) X X X X
1328-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1329option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001330option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001331option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001332option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001333option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001334option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001335option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1336option httpchk X - X X
1337option httpclose (*) X X X X
1338option httplog X X X X
1339option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001340option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001341option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001342option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1343option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1344option logasap (*) X X X -
1345option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001346option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001347option nolinger (*) X X X X
1348option originalto X X X X
1349option persist (*) X - X X
1350option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001351option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001352option smtpchk X - X X
1353option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1354option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1355option splice-request (*) X X X X
1356option splice-response (*) X X X X
1357option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1358option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1359-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001360option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001361option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1362option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1363option tcpka X X X X
1364option tcplog X X X X
1365option transparent (*) X - X X
1366persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1367rate-limit sessions X X X -
1368redirect - X X X
1369redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1370redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1371reqadd - X X X
1372reqallow - X X X
1373reqdel - X X X
1374reqdeny - X X X
1375reqiallow - X X X
1376reqidel - X X X
1377reqideny - X X X
1378reqipass - X X X
1379reqirep - X X X
1380reqisetbe - X X X
1381reqitarpit - X X X
1382reqpass - X X X
1383reqrep - X X X
1384-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1385reqsetbe - X X X
1386reqtarpit - X X X
1387retries X - X X
1388rspadd - X X X
1389rspdel - X X X
1390rspdeny - X X X
1391rspidel - X X X
1392rspideny - X X X
1393rspirep - X X X
1394rsprep - X X X
1395server - - X X
1396source X - X X
1397srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001398stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399stats auth X - X X
1400stats enable X - X X
1401stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001402stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001403stats realm X - X X
1404stats refresh X - X X
1405stats scope X - X X
1406stats show-desc X - X X
1407stats show-legends X - X X
1408stats show-node X - X X
1409stats uri X - X X
1410-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1411stick match - - X X
1412stick on - - X X
1413stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001414stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001416tcp-check connect - - X X
1417tcp-check expect - - X X
1418tcp-check send - - X X
1419tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001420tcp-request connection - X X -
1421tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001422tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001423tcp-response content - - X X
1424tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425timeout check X - X X
1426timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001427timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001428timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1429timeout connect X - X X
1430timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1431timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1432timeout http-request X X X X
1433timeout queue X - X X
1434timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001435timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001436timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1437timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001438timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001440unique-id-format X X X -
1441unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001442use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001443use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001444------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1445 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014484.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1449---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001450
1451This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1452
1453
1454acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1455 Declare or complete an access list.
1456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1457 no | yes | yes | yes
1458 Example:
1459 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1460 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1461 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001463 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464
1465
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001466appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1467 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001468 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1470 no | no | yes | yes
1471 Arguments :
1472 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1473 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1474
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476 checked in each cookie value.
1477
1478 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1479 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1480 milliseconds.
1481
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001482 request-learn
1483 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1484 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1485 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1486 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1487 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1488 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1491 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1492 data following this prefix.
1493
1494 Example :
1495 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1496
1497 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1498 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1499
1500 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1501 2 modes are currently supported :
1502 - path-parameters :
1503 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1504 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1505 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1506 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1507 - query-string :
1508 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1509 query string.
1510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001511 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1512 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1513 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1514 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001515 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1516 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1517 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001518 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1519 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1520
1521 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1522
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001523 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1524 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1525 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 Example :
1528 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1529
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001530 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1531 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532
1533
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001534backlog <conns>
1535 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1537 yes | yes | yes | no
1538 Arguments :
1539 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1540 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001541 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001542
1543 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1544 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1545 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1546 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1547 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1548 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1549 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1550 backlog parameter.
1551
1552 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1553 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1554 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1555
1556 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1557
1558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001559balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001560balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1563 yes | no | yes | yes
1564 Arguments :
1565 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1566 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1567 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1568 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1569
1570 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1571 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1572 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1573 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001574 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001575 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001576 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1577 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1578 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1579 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1580 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1581 it, so that you don't worry.
1582
1583 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1584 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1585 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1586 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1587 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1588 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1589 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1590 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001592 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1593 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1594 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1595 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1596 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1597 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1598 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1599 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1600
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001601 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001602 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001603 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1604 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001605 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001606 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1607 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1608 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1609 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1610 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001611 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1612 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1613 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1614 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1615 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1616 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1619 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1620 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1621 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1622 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1623 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1624 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1625 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001626 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001628 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1629 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1630 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001631
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001632 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1633 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1634 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1635 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1636 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1637 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1638 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1639 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1640 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1641 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1642 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1643 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001644
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001645 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001646 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1647 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1648 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1649 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1650 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1651 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1652 URIs start with a leading "/".
1653
1654 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1655 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1656 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1657 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001660 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1661
1662 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001663 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1664 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001665 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1666 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1667 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1668 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001669 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001670 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1671 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001672
1673 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1674 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1675 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1676 server will receive the request.
1677
1678 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1679 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1680 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1681 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1682 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001683 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1684 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1685 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001687 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1688 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1689 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1690 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1691 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001693 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001694 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1695 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1696 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1697
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1699 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1700 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1701
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001702 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001703 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001704 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1705 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1706 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1707 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1708 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1709 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001710 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001711 used instead.
1712
1713 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1714 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1715 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1716 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1717
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001718 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1719 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1720 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1721
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001722 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001725 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1726 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001727
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001728 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1729 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1730 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731
1732 Examples :
1733 balance roundrobin
1734 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001735 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001736 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1737 balance hdr(host)
1738 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001739
1740 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1741 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001743 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001744 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1745 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1746 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1747 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1748
1749 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1750 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1751 defaults to 16 kB.
1752
1753 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1754 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1755
1756 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1757 Round Robin.
1758
1759 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1760 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1761 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1762 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1763
1764 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1765
1766 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001768 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1769 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1770 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001772 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1773 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
1775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001776bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1777bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1780 no | yes | yes | no
1781 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001782 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1783 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1784 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1785 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001786 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001787 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1788 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1789 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1790 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1791 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1792 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1793 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001794 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1795 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1796 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1797 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1798 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1799 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1800 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001801 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1802 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1803 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001804 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1805 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1806 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1807 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001808
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001809 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1810 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001811 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1812 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1813 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001814 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1815 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1816 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1817 the range.
1818
1819 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1820 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1821 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1822 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1823 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1824 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1825 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001826 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001827 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001829 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1830 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1831 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1832 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1833 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1834 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1835 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1836 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1837
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001838 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1839 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1840 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1841 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1844 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1845 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1846 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1847 in a frontend.
1848
1849 Example :
1850 listen http_proxy
1851 bind :80,:443
1852 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001853 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001855 listen http_https_proxy
1856 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001857 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001858
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001859 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1860 bind ipv6@:80
1861 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1862 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1863
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001864 listen external_bind_app1
1865 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1866
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001867 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001868 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
1870
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001871bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001872 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1874 yes | yes | yes | yes
1875 Arguments :
1876 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1877 may be used to override a default value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001879 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001880 option may be combined with other numbers.
1881
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001882 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001883 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1884 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1885 missing from all processes.
1886
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001887 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001888 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001889 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1890 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1891 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1892 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001893
1894 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1895 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1896 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1897 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1898 and 'even' instances.
1899
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001900 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1901 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1902 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1903 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001904
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001905 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1906 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1907
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001908 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1909 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1910 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1911
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001912 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1913 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1914
1915 Example :
1916 listen app_ip1
1917 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001918 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919
1920 listen app_ip2
1921 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001922 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001923
1924 listen management
1925 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001926 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001928 listen management
1929 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1930 bind-process 1-4
1931
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001932 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001933
1934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001935block { if | unless } <condition>
1936 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1938 no | yes | yes | yes
1939
1940 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1941 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001942 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001943 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001944 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1945 "block" statements per instance.
1946
1947 Example:
1948 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1949 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1950 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1951 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001953 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
1955
1956capture cookie <name> len <length>
1957 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1959 no | yes | yes | no
1960 Arguments :
1961 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1962 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1963 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1964 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1965 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1966
1967 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1968 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1969 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1970 right if it exceeds <length>.
1971
1972 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1973 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1974 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1975 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1976
1977 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1978 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1979 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1980
1981 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1982 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1983 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001984 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1985 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1986 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987
1988 Example:
1989 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1990
1991 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001992 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994
1995capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001996 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1998 no | yes | yes | no
1999 Arguments :
2000 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002001 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2003 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2004 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2005
2006 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2007 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2008 it exceeds <length>.
2009
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002010 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2012 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002013 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2014 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2015 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2016 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002017 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002018 environments to find where the request came from.
2019
2020 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2021 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2022 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2023 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002025 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2026 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2027 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2028 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2029 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002030
2031 Example:
2032 capture request header Host len 15
2033 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2034 capture request header Referrer len 15
2035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002036 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002037 about logging.
2038
2039
2040capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002041 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2043 no | yes | yes | no
2044 Arguments :
2045 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002046 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2048 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2049 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2050
2051 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2052 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2053 it exceeds <length>.
2054
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002055 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2057 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2058 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002059 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2060 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2061 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2062 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002064 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2065 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2066 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2067 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2068 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069
2070 Example:
2071 capture response header Content-length len 9
2072 capture response header Location len 15
2073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002074 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002075 about logging.
2076
2077
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002078clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2081 yes | yes | yes | no
2082 Arguments :
2083 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2085 as explained at the top of this document.
2086
2087 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2088 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2089 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2090 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2091 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2092 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2093 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2094 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002095 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2097 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2098
2099 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2100 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2101 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2102 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2103 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2104 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2105
2106 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2107 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2108
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002109 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2110 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002112compression algo <algorithm> ...
2113compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002114compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002115 Enable HTTP compression.
2116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2117 yes | yes | yes | yes
2118 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002119 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2120 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2121 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2122
2123 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002124 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002125 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2126 data.
2127
2128 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2129 support for zlib was built in.
2130
2131 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2132 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2133 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2134 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2135 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2136 in.
2137
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002138 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002139 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002140 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2141 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2142 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2143 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2144 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002145
2146 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2147 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2148 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2149 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2150 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002151 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2152 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2153 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2154 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2155 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002156 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2157 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002158
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002159 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002160 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2161 "Accept-Encoding" header
2162 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002163 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002164 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2165 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002166 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2167 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2168 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2169 "multipart"
2170 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2171 header
2172 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2173 and later
2174 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2175 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002176
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002177 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2178 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002179
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002180 Examples :
2181 compression algo gzip
2182 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002184contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2187 yes | no | yes | yes
2188 Arguments :
2189 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2191 as explained at the top of this document.
2192
2193 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002194 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002195 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002196 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2197 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2198 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2199 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2200
2201 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2202 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2203 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2204 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2205 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2206 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2207
2208 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2209 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2210 instead.
2211
2212 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2213 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2214
2215
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002216cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002217 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2218 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2221 yes | no | yes | yes
2222 Arguments :
2223 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2224 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2225 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2226 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2227 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2228 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2229 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2230 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2231 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2232
2233 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2234 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2235 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2236 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2237 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2238 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2239 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2240 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2241 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2242 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2243 "insert" and "prefix".
2244
2245 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002246 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002247
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002248 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002249 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2250 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2251 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2252 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2253 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2254 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2255 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2256 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2257 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2258 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
2260 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2261 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2262 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2263 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2264 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2265 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2266 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2267 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2268 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2269 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002270 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2271 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2272 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002273
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002274 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2275 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2276 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002277 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2278 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2279 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2280 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002281 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2282 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2283 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
2285 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2286 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2287 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2288 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2289 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2290 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2291 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2292 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2293 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2294
2295 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2296 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2297 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2298 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2299 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2300 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2301 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2302 persistence cookie in the cache.
2303 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2304
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002305 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2306 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2307 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2308 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2309 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2310 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2311 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2312 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2313 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2314 they logout.
2315
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002316 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2317 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2318 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2319 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2320
2321 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2322 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2323 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2324 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2325 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2326 this attribute.
2327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002328 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002329 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002330 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2331 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2332 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2333 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2334 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2335 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002336
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002337 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2338 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2339 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2340 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2341 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2342 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2343 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2344 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2345 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2346 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2347 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2348 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2349 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2350 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2351 the site.
2352
2353 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2354 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2355 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2356 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2357 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2358 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2359 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2360 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2361 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2362 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2363 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2364 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2365 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2366 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2367 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2368 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2369
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002370 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2371 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2372 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2373 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 Examples :
2376 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2377 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2378 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002379 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002381 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002382 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002385default-server [param*]
2386 Change default options for a server in a backend
2387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2388 yes | no | yes | yes
2389 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002390 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2391 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2392 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2393 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002394
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002395 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002396 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2397
2398 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401default_backend <backend>
2402 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2404 yes | yes | yes | no
2405 Arguments :
2406 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2407
2408 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2409 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2410 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2411 will catch all undetermined requests.
2412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413 Example :
2414
2415 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2416 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2417 default_backend dynamic
2418
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002419 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002422description <string>
2423 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2425 no | yes | yes | yes
2426 Arguments : string
2427
2428 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2429 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2430 it describes.
2431 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2432
2433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434disabled
2435 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2437 yes | yes | yes | yes
2438 Arguments : none
2439
2440 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2441 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2442 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2443 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2444 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2445 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2446 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2447
2448 See also : "enabled"
2449
2450
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002451dispatch <address>:<port>
2452 Set a default server address
2453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2454 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002455 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002456
2457 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2458 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2459 during start-up.
2460
2461 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2462 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2463 possible with normal servers.
2464
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002465 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002466 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2467 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2468 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2469 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2470
2471 See also : "server"
2472
2473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474enabled
2475 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 yes | yes | yes | yes
2478 Arguments : none
2479
2480 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2481 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2482
2483 See also : "disabled"
2484
2485
2486errorfile <code> <file>
2487 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | yes | yes | yes
2490 Arguments :
2491 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002492 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493
2494 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002495 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002496 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002497 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2498 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
2500 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2501 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2502 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2503
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002504 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2507 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2508 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2509 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2510
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002511 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2512 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2513 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2514 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2515 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2516 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2519 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2520 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002521 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2523
2524 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 Example :
2527 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002528 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002529 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2530 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002532
2533errorloc <code> <url>
2534errorloc302 <code> <url>
2535 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2537 yes | yes | yes | yes
2538 Arguments :
2539 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002540 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002541
2542 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2543 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2544 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2545 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2546 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2547
2548 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2549 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2550 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2551
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002552 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002554 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2555 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2556 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2557 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2558 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2559 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2560 request.
2561
2562 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2563
2564
2565errorloc303 <code> <url>
2566 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 yes | yes | yes | yes
2569 Arguments :
2570 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2571 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2572
2573 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2574 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2575 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2576 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2577 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2578
2579 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2580 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2581 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2582
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002583 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002585 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2586 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2587 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2588 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002589 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590
2591 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2592
2593
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002594force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2595 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2597 no | yes | yes | yes
2598
2599 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2600 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2601 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2602 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2603 marked down for maintenance operations.
2604
2605 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2606 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2607 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2608 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2609 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2610 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2611 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2612 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2613 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2614
2615 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2616 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2617 is used.
2618
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002619 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002620 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002621
2622
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002623fullconn <conns>
2624 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 yes | no | yes | yes
2627 Arguments :
2628 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2629 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2630
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002631 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002632 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002633 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002634 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2635 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2636 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2637 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2638 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002639 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002640
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002641 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2642 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002643 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2644 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2645 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 Example :
2648 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2649 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2650 # connections.
2651 backend dynamic
2652 fullconn 10000
2653 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2654 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2655
2656 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2657
2658
2659grace <time>
2660 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002662 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663 Arguments :
2664 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2665 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2666 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2667
2668 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2669 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002670 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2672
2673 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2674 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2675 simplify it.
2676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002678hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002679 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2681 yes | no | yes | yes
2682 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002683 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2684 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002685
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002686 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2687 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2688 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2689 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2690 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2691 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2692 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2693 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2694 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2695 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002696
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002697 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2698 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2699 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2700 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2701 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2702 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2703 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2704 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2705 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2706 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2707 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2708 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2709 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002710 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2711 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712
2713 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2714
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002715 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002716 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2717 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2718 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002719 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2720 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2721 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002722
2723 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2724 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2726 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2727 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2728 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2729
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002730 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2731 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2732 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2733 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2734 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2735 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2736 parameter.
2737
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002738 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2739
2740 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2741 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2742 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2743 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2744 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2745 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2746 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2747 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2748 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2749 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2750 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2751 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002752
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002753 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2754 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2755 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002756
2757 See also : "balance", "server"
2758
2759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760http-check disable-on-404
2761 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002763 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764 Arguments : none
2765
2766 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2767 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2768 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2769 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2770 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2771 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2772 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2773 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002774 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2775 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2776 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2777
2778 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2779
2780
2781http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002782 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002784 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002785 Arguments :
2786 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2787 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002788 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2790 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2791 details on the supported keywords.
2792
2793 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2794 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2795 with the usual backslash ('\').
2796
2797 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2798 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2799 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2800 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2801 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2802
2803 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002804 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002805 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2806 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2807 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2808
2809 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002810 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002811 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2812 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2813 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2814 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2815
2816 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002817 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002818 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2819 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2820 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2821 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2822 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2823 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2824 trace).
2825
2826 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002827 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002828 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2829 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2830 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2831 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2832 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2833 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2834
2835 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2836 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2837 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2838 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2839 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2840 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2841 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2842 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2843
2844 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2845 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2846
2847 Examples :
2848 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002849 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002850
2851 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002852 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002853
2854 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002855 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002856
2857 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002858 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002860 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002861
2862
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002863http-check send-state
2864 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2866 yes | no | yes | yes
2867 Arguments : none
2868
2869 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2870 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2871 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2872 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2873 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2874
2875 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2876 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2877 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2878 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2879 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2880 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2881 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2882 checked in multiple backends.
2883
2884 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2885 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2886
2887 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2888 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2889 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2890 one fails.
2891
2892 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2893 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2894 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2895
2896 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2897 server's queue.
2898
2899 Example of a header received by the application server :
2900 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2901 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2902
2903 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2904
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002905http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002906 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002907 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002908 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2909 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002910 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2911 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2912 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2913 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2914 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2915 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002916 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2918
2919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2920 no | yes | yes | yes
2921
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002922 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2923 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2924 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2925 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2926 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002927
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002928 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2929 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2930 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2931
2932 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2933 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2934 are evaluated.
2935
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002936 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2937 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2938 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2939 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2940 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2941 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2942 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2943 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2944 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002945 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002946 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2947
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002948 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2949 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2950 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2951 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2952 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2953
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002954 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2955 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2956 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002957 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2958 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002959
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002960 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2961 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2962 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2963 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2964 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2965 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2966 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2967 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2968
2969 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2970 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2971 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2972 external users.
2973
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002974 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2975 <name>.
2976
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002977 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2978 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2979 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2980 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2981 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2982 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2983 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2984 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2985
2986 Example:
2987
2988 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2989
2990 applied to:
2991
2992 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2993
2994 outputs:
2995
2996 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2997
2998 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
2999
3000 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3001 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3002 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3003 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3004 header.
3005
3006 Example:
3007
3008 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3009
3010 applied to:
3011
3012 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3013
3014 outputs:
3015
3016 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3017
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003018 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3019 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3020 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3021 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3022 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3023 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3024 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3025 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3026
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003027 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3028 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3029 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3030 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3031 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3032 another equipment.
3033
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003034 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3035 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3036 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3037 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3038 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3039 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3040 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3041 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3042
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003043 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3044 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3045 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3046 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3047 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3048 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3049 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3050 admin privileges.
3051
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003052 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3053 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3054 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3055 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3056 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3057 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3058 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3059 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3060
3061 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3062 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3063 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3064 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3065 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3066 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3067
3068 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3069 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3070 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3071 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3072 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3073 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3074
3075 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3076 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3077 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3078 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3079 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3080 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3081 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3082 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3083 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3084
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003085 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3086
3087 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3088 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3089 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3090 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003091
3092 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003093 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3094 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3095 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003096
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003097 http-request allow if nagios
3098 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3099 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3100 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003101
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003102 Example:
3103 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003104 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003105
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003106 Example:
3107 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3108 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3109 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3110 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3111 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3112 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3113 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3114 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3115 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3116
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003117 Example:
3118 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3119 acl add path /addacl
3120 acl del path /delacl
3121
3122 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3123
3124 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3125 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3126
3127 Example:
3128 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3129 acl setmap path /setmap
3130 acl delmap path /delmap
3131
3132 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3133
3134 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3135 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3136
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003137 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3138 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003139
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003140http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003141 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003142 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3143 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003144 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3145 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3146 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3147 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3148 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3149 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003150 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003151 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3152
3153 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3154 no | yes | yes | yes
3155
3156 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3157 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3158 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3159 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3160 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3161 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3162
3163 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3164 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3165 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3166 current section.
3167
3168 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3169 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3170 rules are evaluated.
3171
3172 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3173 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3174 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3175 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3176 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3177 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3178 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3179
3180 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3181 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3182 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3183 external users.
3184
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003185 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3186 <name>.
3187
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003188 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3189 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3190 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3191 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3192 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3193 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3194 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3195 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3196
3197 Example:
3198
3199 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3200
3201 applied to:
3202
3203 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3204
3205 outputs:
3206
3207 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3208
3209 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3210
3211 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3212 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3213 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3214 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3215 header.
3216
3217 Example:
3218
3219 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3220
3221 applied to:
3222
3223 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3224
3225 outputs:
3226
3227 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3228
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003229 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3230 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3231 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3232 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3233 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3234 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3235 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3236 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3237
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003238 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3239 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3240 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3241 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3242 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3243 another equipment.
3244
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003245 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3246 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3247 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3248 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3249 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3250 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3251 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3252 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3253
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003254 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3255 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3256 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3257 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3258 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3259 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3260 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3261 admin privileges.
3262
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003263 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3264 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3265 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3266 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3267 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3268 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3269 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3270 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3271
3272 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3273 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3274 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3275 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3276 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3277 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3278
3279 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3280 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3281 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3282 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3283 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3284 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3285
3286 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3287 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3288 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3289 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3290 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3291 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3292 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3293 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3294 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3295
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003296 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3297
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003298 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003299 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3300 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3301 rules.
3302
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003303 Example:
3304 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3305
3306 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3307
3308 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3309 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3310
3311 Example:
3312 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3313
3314 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3315
3316 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3317 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3318
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003319 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3320 ACL usage.
3321
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003322
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003323http-send-name-header [<header>]
3324 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3325
3326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3327 yes | no | yes | yes
3328
3329 Arguments :
3330
3331 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3332
3333 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3334 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3335 is added with the header string proved.
3336
3337 See also : "server"
3338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003339id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003340 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3342 no | yes | yes | yes
3343 Arguments : none
3344
3345 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3346 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3347 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003348
3349
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003350ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3351 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3353 no | yes | yes | yes
3354
3355 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3356 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3357 and running).
3358
3359 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3360 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3361 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003362 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003363 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3364
3365 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3366 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3367
3368 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3369 "unless" condition is met.
3370
3371 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3372
3373
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003374log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003375log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003376no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003377 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3379 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003380
3381 Prefix :
3382 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3383 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3384 prefix does not allow arguments.
3385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003386 Arguments :
3387 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3388 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3389 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3390 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3391 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3392 parameter.
3393
3394 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3395 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3396
3397 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3398 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3399 standard syslog port).
3400
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003401 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3402 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3403 standard syslog port).
3404
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003405 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3406 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3407 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3408 appropriately writeable).
3409
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003410 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3411 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3412 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3413 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3414
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003415 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3416 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3417 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3418 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3419 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3420 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3421 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3422 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3423 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3424 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3425 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3426
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003427 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3428
3429 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3430 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3431 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3432
3433 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3434 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3435 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003436 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3437 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3438 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3439 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3440 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003441
3442 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3443
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003444 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3445 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3446 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003447
3448 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3449 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3450 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3451 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3452
3453 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3454 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003455
3456 Example :
3457 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003458 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3459 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003460 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3461
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003463log-format <string>
3464 Allows you to custom a log line.
3465
3466 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003469max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3470 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3472 yes | no | yes | yes
3473
3474 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3475 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3476 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3477 servers.
3478
3479 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3480 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3481 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3482 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3483 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3484 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3485 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3486 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3487 picking a different server.
3488
3489 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3490 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3491 even if they have to be queued.
3492
3493 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3494 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3495
3496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003497maxconn <conns>
3498 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3500 yes | yes | yes | no
3501 Arguments :
3502 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3503 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3504 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3505 closes.
3506
3507 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3508 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3509 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3510 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3511 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3512 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3513 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3514 properly tuned.
3515
3516 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3517 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3518 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3519
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003520 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003522 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3523
3524
3525mode { tcp|http|health }
3526 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3528 yes | yes | yes | yes
3529 Arguments :
3530 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3531 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3532 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3533 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3534
3535 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3536 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3537 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3538 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3539 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3540
3541 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003542 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3543 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3544 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3545 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3546 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3547 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3548 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003549
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003550 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3551 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3552 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003554 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003555 defaults http_instances
3556 mode http
3557
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003558 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003560
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003561monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003562 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3564 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565 Arguments :
3566 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3567 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003568 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3570 backend and its backup.
3571
3572 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3573 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3574 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3575 servers in a list of backends.
3576
3577 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3578 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3579 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3580 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3581 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3582 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3583 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003584 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3585 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
3587 Example:
3588 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003589 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3591 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3592 monitor-uri /site_alive
3593 monitor fail if site_dead
3594
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003595 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003596
3597
3598monitor-net <source>
3599 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | no
3602 Arguments :
3603 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3604 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3605 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3606 followed by a mask.
3607
3608 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3609 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003610 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3612
3613 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3614 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3615 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3616 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003617 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3618 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3619 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003620
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003621 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3622 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3623 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3624 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3625 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3626 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003627
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003628 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3629 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003630
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631 Example :
3632 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3633 frontend www
3634 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3635
3636 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3637
3638
3639monitor-uri <uri>
3640 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | yes | yes | no
3643 Arguments :
3644 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3645 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3646
3647 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3648 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3649 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3650 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3651 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3652 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3653 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3654 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3655
3656 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3657 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3658 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3659 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3660 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3661 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3662
3663 Example :
3664 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3665 frontend www
3666 mode http
3667 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3668
3669 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003672option abortonclose
3673no option abortonclose
3674 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 yes | no | yes | yes
3677 Arguments : none
3678
3679 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3680 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3681 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3682 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003683 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3685 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3686 encountered while delivering the response.
3687
3688 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3689 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3690 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3691 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3692 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3693 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003694 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003696 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003697 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3698 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3699 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3700
3701 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3702 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3703 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3704 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3705 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3706 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3707 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3708 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003709 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003710
3711 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3712 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3713
3714 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3715
3716
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003717option accept-invalid-http-request
3718no option accept-invalid-http-request
3719 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | no
3722 Arguments : none
3723
3724 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3725 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3726 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3727 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3728 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3729 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3730 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3731 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003732 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3733 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3734 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3735 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3736 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3737 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003738
3739 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3740 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3741 been confirmed.
3742
3743 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3744 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003745 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3746 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003747 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3748
3749 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3750 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3751
3752 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3753 stats socket.
3754
3755
3756option accept-invalid-http-response
3757no option accept-invalid-http-response
3758 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3760 yes | no | yes | yes
3761 Arguments : none
3762
3763 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3764 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3765 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3766 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3767 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3768 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3769 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3770 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3771 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3772
3773 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3774 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3775 been confirmed.
3776
3777 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3778 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3779 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3780 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3781
3782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3784
3785 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3786 stats socket.
3787
3788
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003789option allbackups
3790no option allbackups
3791 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 yes | no | yes | yes
3794 Arguments : none
3795
3796 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3797 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3798 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3799 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3800 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3801 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3802 order between the backup servers anymore.
3803
3804 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3805 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3806
3807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3809
3810
3811option checkcache
3812no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003813 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3815 yes | no | yes | yes
3816 Arguments : none
3817
3818 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3819 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003820 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003821 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3822 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003823 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003824
3825 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003826 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003827 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3829 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003830 to the client are :
3831 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003832 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003833 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003834 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3835 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3836 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3837 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3838 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3839 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3840 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3841 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3842 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3843 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3844 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3845
3846 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003847 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003848 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003849 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3851
3852 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3853 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003854 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003855 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3856
3857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3859
3860
3861option clitcpka
3862no option clitcpka
3863 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | yes | yes | no
3866 Arguments : none
3867
3868 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3869 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3870 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3871 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3872
3873 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3874 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3875 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3876 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3877
3878 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3879 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3880 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3881 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3882 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3883
3884 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3885
3886 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3887 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3888 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3889
3890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3892
3893 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3894
3895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896option contstats
3897 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 yes | yes | yes | no
3900 Arguments : none
3901
3902 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3903 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3904 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3905 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3906 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3907 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3908 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3909
3910
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003911option dontlog-normal
3912no option dontlog-normal
3913 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | yes | yes | no
3916 Arguments : none
3917
3918 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3919 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3920 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3921 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3922 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3923 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3924 logged.
3925
3926 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3927 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3928 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003930 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003931 logging.
3932
3933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003934option dontlognull
3935no option dontlognull
3936 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3938 yes | yes | yes | no
3939 Arguments : none
3940
3941 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3942 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3943 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3944 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3945 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3946 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3947 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3948
3949 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3950 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3951 would not be logged.
3952
3953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003956 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003957
3958
3959option forceclose
3960no option forceclose
3961 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003963 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003964 Arguments : none
3965
3966 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3967 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3968 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3969 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3970 global session times in the logs.
3971
3972 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003973 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003974 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003975
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003976 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3977 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3978 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3979
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003980 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3981 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003982
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3985
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003986 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003987
3988
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003989option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003990 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 yes | yes | yes | yes
3993 Arguments :
3994 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3995 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003996 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003997 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003998
3999 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4000 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4001 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4002 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4003 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4004 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4005 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004006 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4007 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4008 possible that the client has already brought one.
4009
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004010 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004011 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004012 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4013 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004014 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4015 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004016
4017 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4018 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4019 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4020 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4021 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4022 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4023 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4024
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004025 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4026 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4027 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4028 are under the control of the end-user.
4029
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004030 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004031 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4032 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004033 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4034 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4035 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004036
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004037 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004038 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4039 frontend www
4040 mode http
4041 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4042
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004043 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4044 backend www
4045 mode http
4046 option forwardfor header X-Client
4047
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004048 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004049 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004050
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004051
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004052option http-keep-alive
4053no option http-keep-alive
4054 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4056 yes | yes | yes | yes
4057 Arguments : none
4058
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004059 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4060 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4061 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4062 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4063 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4064 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4065 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4066
4067 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4068 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004069 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4070 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4071 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4072 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4073 situations where this option may be useful :
4074
4075 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4076 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4077
4078 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4079 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4080
4081 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4082 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4083 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4084 request.
4085
4086 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4087 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004088 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4089 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4090 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004091
4092 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4093 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4094
4095 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4096 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4097 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4098 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4099 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4100 not set.
4101
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004102 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4103 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004104 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004105 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004106
4107 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004108 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4109 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004110
4111
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004112option http-no-delay
4113no option http-no-delay
4114 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4116 yes | yes | yes | yes
4117 Arguments : none
4118
4119 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4120 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4121 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4122 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4123 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4124 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4125 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4126 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4127 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4128 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4129 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4130 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4131 affected.
4132
4133 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4134 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4135 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4136 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4137 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4138 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4139 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4140 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4141 latency environments.
4142
4143
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004144option http-pretend-keepalive
4145no option http-pretend-keepalive
4146 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | yes | yes | yes
4149 Arguments : none
4150
4151 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4152 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4153 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4154 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4155 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4156 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4157 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4158 consider the response complete.
4159
4160 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4161 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4162 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4163 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4164 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4165 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4166
4167 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4168 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4169 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4170 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4171 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4172 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4173 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4174
4175 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4176 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004177 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004178 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4179 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004180
4181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4183
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004184 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4185 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004186
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004187
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004188option http-server-close
4189no option http-server-close
4190 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | yes
4193 Arguments : none
4194
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004195 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4196 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4197 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4198 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4199 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4200 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4201 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4202 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4203 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4204 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4205 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4206 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4207 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4208 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4209 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4210 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004211
4212 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4213 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4214 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4215 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004216 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4217 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004218
4219 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4220 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004221 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4222 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004223 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4224 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004225
4226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4228
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004229 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004230 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4231 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004232
4233
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004234option http-tunnel
4235no option http-tunnel
4236 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4238 yes | yes | yes | yes
4239 Arguments : none
4240
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004241 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4242 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4243 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4244 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4245 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4246 "option http-tunnel".
4247
4248 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004249 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004250 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4251 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4252 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4253 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4254 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4255 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4256 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004257
4258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4260
4261 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4262 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4263 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4264
4265
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004266option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004267no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004268 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4270 yes | yes | yes | no
4271 Arguments : none
4272
4273 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4274 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4275 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4276 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4277 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4278 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4279 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4280
4281 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4282 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4283 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4284 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4285 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4286 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4287 request along its whole life.
4288
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004289 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4290 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4291 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4292 front of an existing proxy.
4293
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004294 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4295
4296 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4297 http-server-close".
4298
4299
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004300option httpchk
4301option httpchk <uri>
4302option httpchk <method> <uri>
4303option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4304 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4306 yes | no | yes | yes
4307 Arguments :
4308 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4309 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4310 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4311 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4312 ones.
4313
4314 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4315 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4316 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4317
4318 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4319 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4320 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4321 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4322 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4323
4324 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4325 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4326 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4327 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4328 the lack of any response.
4329
4330 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4331
4332 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4333 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4334 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4335
4336 Examples :
4337 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4338 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4339 backend https_relay
4340 mode tcp
4341 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4342 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4343
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004344 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4345 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4346 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004347
4348
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004349option httpclose
4350no option httpclose
4351 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4353 yes | yes | yes | yes
4354 Arguments : none
4355
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004356 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4357 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4358 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4359 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004360 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004361 "option http-tunnel".
4362
4363 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4364 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4365 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4366 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4367 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4368 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4369 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4370 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004371
4372 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004373 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004374 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4375 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4376 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4377 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4378 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004379
4380 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4381 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004382 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4383 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004384 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4385 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004386
4387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4389
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004390 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4391 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004392
4393
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004394option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004395 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004398 Arguments :
4399 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4400 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4401 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4402 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4403 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004404
4405 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4406 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4407 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4408 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4409 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4410 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4411 ports.
4412
4413 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4414
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004415 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4416 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4417 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4418 by default.
4419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004420 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004421
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004422
4423option http_proxy
4424no option http_proxy
4425 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4427 yes | yes | yes | yes
4428 Arguments : none
4429
4430 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4431 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4432 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4433 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4434 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4435
4436 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4437 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4438 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4439 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004440 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004441 be analyzed.
4442
4443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4445
4446 Example :
4447 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4448 backend direct_forward
4449 option httpclose
4450 option http_proxy
4451
4452 See also : "option httpclose"
4453
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004454
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004455option independent-streams
4456no option independent-streams
4457 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4459 yes | yes | yes | yes
4460 Arguments : none
4461
4462 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4463 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4464 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4465 receive data or not.
4466
4467 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4468 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4469 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4470 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4471 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4472 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4473 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4474 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4475 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4476 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4477 socket buffers.
4478
4479 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4480 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4481 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4482 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4483 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4484
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004485 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004486 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4487 deprecated.
4488
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004489 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004490
4491
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004492option ldap-check
4493 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 yes | no | yes | yes
4496 Arguments : none
4497
4498 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4499 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4500 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4501 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4502
4503 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4504 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4505
4506 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4507 configure it.
4508
4509 Example :
4510 option ldap-check
4511
4512 See also : "option httpchk"
4513
4514
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004515option log-health-checks
4516no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004517 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4519 yes | no | yes | yes
4520 Arguments : none
4521
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004522 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4523 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4524 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004525
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004526 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4527 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4528 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4529 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4530 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4531
4532 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4533 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004534
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004535 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4536 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4537 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004538
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004539
4540option log-separate-errors
4541no option log-separate-errors
4542 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | yes | yes | no
4545 Arguments : none
4546
4547 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4548 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4549 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4550 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4551 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4552 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4553 provides very important information.
4554
4555 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4556 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4557 error logs.
4558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004559 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004560 logging.
4561
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004562
4563option logasap
4564no option logasap
4565 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 yes | yes | yes | no
4568 Arguments : none
4569
4570 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4571 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4572 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4573 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4574 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4575 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4576 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004577 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004578 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4579 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4580
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004581 Examples :
4582 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4583 mode http
4584 option httplog
4585 option logasap
4586 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4587
4588 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4589 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4590 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4591 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004593 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004594 logging.
4595
4596
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004597option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004598 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004601 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004602 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4603 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004604 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004605
4606 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4607 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4608 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4609 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4610 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4611 in the MySQL table, like this :
4612
4613 USE mysql;
4614 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4615 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4616
4617 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4618 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4619 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4620 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4621 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4622 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4623 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4624 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4625 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4626
4627 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4628 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004629
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004630 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004631
4632 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4633 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4634 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4635 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4636 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4637 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4638
4639 See also: "option httpchk"
4640
4641
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004642option nolinger
4643no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004644 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004647 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004648
4649 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4650 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4651 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4652 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4653 connections.
4654
4655 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4656 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4657 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4658 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4659 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4660 this too.
4661
4662 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4663 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4664 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4665
4666 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4667 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4668 for servers.
4669
4670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4672
4673
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004674option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4675 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | yes | yes | yes
4678 Arguments :
4679 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4680 matching <network>
4681 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4682 header name.
4683
4684 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4685 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4686 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4687 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4688 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4689 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4690 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4691 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4692 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4693 possible that the client has already brought one.
4694
4695 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4696 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4697 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4698 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4699 header and requires different one.
4700
4701 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4702 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4703 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4704 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4705 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4706 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4707 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4708
4709 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4710 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4711 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4712 both are defined.
4713
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004714 Examples :
4715 # Original Destination address
4716 frontend www
4717 mode http
4718 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4719
4720 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4721 backend www
4722 mode http
4723 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4724
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004725 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4726 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004727
4728
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004729option persist
4730no option persist
4731 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004734 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004735
4736 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4737 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4738 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4739 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4740 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4741 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4742 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4743 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4744 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4745 redirected to another valid server.
4746
4747 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4748 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4749
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004750 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004751
4752
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004753option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4754 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4756 yes | no | yes | yes
4757 Arguments :
4758 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4759 PostgreSQL server.
4760
4761 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4762 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4763 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4764 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4765
4766 See also: "option httpchk"
4767
4768
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004769option prefer-last-server
4770no option prefer-last-server
4771 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4772 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | no | yes | yes
4774 Arguments : none
4775
4776 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4777 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4778 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4779 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4780 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4781 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4782 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4783 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4784 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004785 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4786 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4787 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4788 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4789 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4790 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4791 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004792
4793 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4794 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4795
4796 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4797
4798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004799option redispatch
4800no option redispatch
4801 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4803 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004804 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004805
4806 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4807 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4808 be able to access the service anymore.
4809
4810 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4811 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4812
4813 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4814 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4815 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004817 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4818 "redisp" keywords.
4819
4820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4822
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004823 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004824
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004825
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004826option redis-check
4827 Use redis health checks for server testing
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 yes | no | yes | yes
4830 Arguments : none
4831
4832 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4833 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4834 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4835 find the "+PONG" response message.
4836
4837 Example :
4838 option redis-check
4839
4840 See also : "option httpchk"
4841
4842
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004843option smtpchk
4844option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4845 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004848 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004849 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4850 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4851 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4852
4853 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4854 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4855 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4856
4857 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4858 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4859 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4860 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4861 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4862 dead server.
4863
4864 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4865 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4866 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4867 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4868
4869 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4870 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4871 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4872 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4873 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4874
4875 Example :
4876 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4877
4878 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004881option socket-stats
4882no option socket-stats
4883
4884 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | no
4887
4888 Arguments : none
4889
4890
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004891option splice-auto
4892no option splice-auto
4893 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4895 yes | yes | yes | yes
4896 Arguments : none
4897
4898 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4899 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4900 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4901 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004902 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004903 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4904 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4905 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4906 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4907
4908 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4909 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4910 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4911 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4912 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4913 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4914 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4915 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4916 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4917 keyword.
4918
4919 Example :
4920 option splice-auto
4921
4922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4924
4925 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4926 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4927
4928
4929option splice-request
4930no option splice-request
4931 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 yes | yes | yes | yes
4934 Arguments : none
4935
4936 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004937 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004938 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4939 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4940 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4941 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4942
4943 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4944
4945 Example :
4946 option splice-request
4947
4948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4950
4951 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4952 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4953
4954
4955option splice-response
4956no option splice-response
4957 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4959 yes | yes | yes | yes
4960 Arguments : none
4961
4962 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004963 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004964 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4965 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4966 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4967 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4968
4969 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4970
4971 Example :
4972 option splice-response
4973
4974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4976
4977 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4978 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4979
4980
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004981option srvtcpka
4982no option srvtcpka
4983 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4985 yes | no | yes | yes
4986 Arguments : none
4987
4988 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4989 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4990 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4991 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4992
4993 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4994 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4995 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4996 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4997
4998 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4999 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5000 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5001 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5002 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5003
5004 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5005
5006 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5007 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5008 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5009
5010 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5011 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5012
5013 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5014
5015
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005016option ssl-hello-chk
5017 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5019 yes | no | yes | yes
5020 Arguments : none
5021
5022 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5023 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5024 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5025 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5026 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5027 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5028 hello message.
5029
5030 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5031 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5032 messages, which is appreciable.
5033
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005034 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5035 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5036 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005037
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005038 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5039
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005040
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005041option tcp-check
5042 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5044 yes | no | yes | yes
5045
5046 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5047 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5048
5049 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5050 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5051 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5052
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005053 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005054 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5055 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5056 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5057 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5058 only.
5059
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005060 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005061 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5062 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5063 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5064 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5065
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005066 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005067 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5068 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005069 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005070 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5071 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5072 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5073 the respective protocols.
5074 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5075 analysed.
5076
5077 Examples :
5078 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5079 option tcp-check
5080 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5081
5082 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5083 option tcp-check
5084 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5085
5086 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5087 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005088 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005089 option tcp-check
5090 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5091 tcp-check expect +PONG
5092 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5093 tcp-check expect string role:master
5094 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5095 tcp-check expect string +OK
5096
5097 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5098 (send many headers before analyzing)
5099 option tcp-check
5100 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5101 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5102 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5103 tcp-check send \r\n
5104 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5105
5106
5107 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5108
5109
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005110option tcp-smart-accept
5111no option tcp-smart-accept
5112 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | yes | yes | no
5115 Arguments : none
5116
5117 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5118 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5119 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5120 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5121 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5122 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5123
5124 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5125 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5126 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5127 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5128
5129 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5130 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5131 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5132 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5133
5134 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5135 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5136 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5137
5138 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5139 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5140 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5141
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005142 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5143
5144
5145option tcp-smart-connect
5146no option tcp-smart-connect
5147 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | no | yes | yes
5150 Arguments : none
5151
5152 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5153 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5154 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5155 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5156 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5157
5158 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5159 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5160 complex.
5161
5162 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5163 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5164 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5165
5166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5168
5169 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5170
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005171
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005172option tcpka
5173 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5175 yes | yes | yes | yes
5176 Arguments : none
5177
5178 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5179 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5180 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5181 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5182
5183 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5184 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5185 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5186 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5187
5188 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5189 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5190 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5191 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5192 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5193
5194 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5195
5196 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5197 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5198 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5199 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5200 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5201 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5202 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5203 backends.
5204
5205 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5206
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005207
5208option tcplog
5209 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5211 yes | yes | yes | yes
5212 Arguments : none
5213
5214 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5215 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5216 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5217 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5218 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5219 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5220 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5221 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5222
5223 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005225 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005226
5227
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005228option transparent
5229no option transparent
5230 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005232 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005233 Arguments : none
5234
5235 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5236 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5237 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5238 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5239 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5240 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5241 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5242 appropriate server.
5243
5244 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5245 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5246
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005247 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005248 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005249
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005250
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005251persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005252persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005253 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5255 yes | no | yes | yes
5256 Arguments :
5257 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005258 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5259 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005260
5261 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5262 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5263 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5264 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5265 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5266 forwarded to this server.
5267
5268 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5269 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5270 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005271 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005272 a single "listen" section.
5273
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005274 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5275 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5276 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5277
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005278 Example :
5279 listen tse-farm
5280 bind :3389
5281 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5282 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5283 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5284 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5285 persist rdp-cookie
5286 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005287 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005288 balance rdp-cookie
5289 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5290 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5291
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005292 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5293 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005294
5295
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005296rate-limit sessions <rate>
5297 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | yes | yes | no
5300 Arguments :
5301 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5302 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5303
5304 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5305 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5306 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5307 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5308 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5309 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5310
5311 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5312 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5313 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5314 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5315
5316 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5317 listen smtp
5318 mode tcp
5319 bind :25
5320 rate-limit sessions 10
5321 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5322
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005323 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5324 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5325 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005326
5327 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5328
5329
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005330redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5331redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5332redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005333 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 no | yes | yes | yes
5336
5337 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005338 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005339
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005340 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005341 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005342 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5343 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5344 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005345
5346 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5347 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5348 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5349 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5350 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005351 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5352 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5353 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5354 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005355
5356 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5357 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5358 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5359 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5360 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5361 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005362 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005363 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005364 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5365 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5366 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005367
5368 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005369 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5370 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5371 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5372 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5373 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5374 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5375 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5376 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005377
5378 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5379 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5380
5381 - "drop-query"
5382 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5383 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5384 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5385 with a location-type redirect.
5386
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005387 - "append-slash"
5388 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5389 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5390 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5391 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5392
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005393 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5394 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5395 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5396 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5397 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5398 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5399 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5400
5401 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5402 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5403 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5404 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5405 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5406 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5407 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005408
5409 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5410 acl clear dst_port 80
5411 acl secure dst_port 8080
5412 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005413 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005414 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005415 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5416
5417 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005418 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5419 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5420 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005421 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005422
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005423 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5424 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5425 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5426
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005427 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005428 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005429
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005430 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5431 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5432 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005434 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005435
5436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005437redisp (deprecated)
5438redispatch (deprecated)
5439 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005442 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005443
5444 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5445 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5446 be able to access the service anymore.
5447
5448 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5449 redistribute them to a working server.
5450
5451 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5452 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5453 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005455 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5456 "option redispatch" instead.
5457
5458 See also : "option redispatch"
5459
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005460
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005461reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005462 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 no | yes | yes | yes
5465 Arguments :
5466 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5467 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005468 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005469
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005470 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5471 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5472
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005473 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5474 the last header of an HTTP request.
5475
5476 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5477 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5478 responses.
5479
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005480 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5481 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5482 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5483
5484 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5485 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486
5487
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005488reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5489reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005490 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5492 no | yes | yes | yes
5493 Arguments :
5494 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5495 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5496 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5497 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5498 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5499 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5500 ignores case.
5501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005502 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5503 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5504
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005505 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5506 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5507 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5508 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005509 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005510
5511 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5512 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5513
5514 Example :
5515 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5516 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5517 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5518
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005519 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5520 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005521
5522
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005523reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5524reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005525 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 no | yes | yes | yes
5528 Arguments :
5529 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5530 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5531 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5532 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5533 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5534 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5535
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005536 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5537 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5538
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005539 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5540 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5541 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5542 next servers.
5543
5544 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5545 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5546 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5547
5548 Example :
5549 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5550 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5551 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5552
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005553 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5554 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005555
5556
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005557reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5558reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005559 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5561 no | yes | yes | yes
5562 Arguments :
5563 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5564 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5565 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5566 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5567 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5568 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5569 case.
5570
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005571 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5572 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5573
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005574 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5575 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5576 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5577 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005578 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005579
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005580 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005581 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005582 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005583
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005584 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5585 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5586
5587 Example :
5588 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5589 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5590 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5591
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005592 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5593 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005594
5595
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005596reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5597reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005598 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 no | yes | yes | yes
5601 Arguments :
5602 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5603 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5604 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5605 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5606 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5607 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5608 case.
5609
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005610 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5611 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5612
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005613 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5614 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5615 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5616 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5617
5618 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5619 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5620
5621 Example :
5622 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5623 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5624 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5625 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5626
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005627 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5628 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005629
5630
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005631reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5632reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005633 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5635 no | yes | yes | yes
5636 Arguments :
5637 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5638 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5639 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5640 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5641 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5642 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5643
5644 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5645 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5646 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5647 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005648 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005649
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005650 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5651 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5652
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005653 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5654 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5655 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5656
5657 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5658 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5659 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5660 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5661 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5662
5663 Example :
5664 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005665 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005666 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5667 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5668
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005669 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5670 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005671
5672
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005673reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5674reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005675 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 no | yes | yes | yes
5678 Arguments :
5679 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5680 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5681 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5682 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5683 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5684 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5685 ignores case.
5686
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005687 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5688 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5689
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005690 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5691 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005692 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5693 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5694 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5696 not set.
5697
5698 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5699 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5700 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5701 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5702 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5703
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005704 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005705 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5706 # block all others.
5707 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5708 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5709
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005710 # block bad guys
5711 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5712 reqitarpit . if badguys
5713
5714 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5715 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005716
5717
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005718retries <value>
5719 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5721 yes | no | yes | yes
5722 Arguments :
5723 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5724 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5725 default value is 3.
5726
5727 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5728 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5729 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5730
5731 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5732 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5733
5734 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5735 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5736
5737 See also : "option redispatch"
5738
5739
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005740rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005741 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 no | yes | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
5745 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5746 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005747 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005748
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005749 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5750 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5751
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005752 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5753 the last header of an HTTP response.
5754
5755 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5756 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5757 responses.
5758
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005759 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5760 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005761
5762
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005763rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5764rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005765 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 no | yes | yes | yes
5768 Arguments :
5769 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5770 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5771 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5772 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5773 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5774 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5775 ignores case.
5776
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005777 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5778 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5779
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005780 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5781 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005782 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005783 client.
5784
5785 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5786 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5787 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5788
5789 Example :
5790 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005791 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005792
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005793 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5794 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005795
5796
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005797rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5798rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005799 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 no | yes | yes | yes
5802 Arguments :
5803 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5804 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5805 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5806 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5807 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5808 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5809 ignores case.
5810
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005811 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5812 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5813
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005814 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5815 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5816 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5817 case-sensitive.
5818
5819 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005820 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5821 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5822 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005823
5824 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5825 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5826
5827 Example :
5828 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5829 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5830
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005831 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5832 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005833
5834
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005835rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5836rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005837 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5839 no | yes | yes | yes
5840 Arguments :
5841 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5842 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5843 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5844 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5845 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5846 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5847 ignores case.
5848
5849 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5850 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5851 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5852 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005853 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005854
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005855 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5856 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5857
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005858 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5859 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5860 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5861
5862 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5863 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5864 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5865 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5866 are not case-sensitive.
5867
5868 Example :
5869 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5870 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5871
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005872 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5873 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005874
5875
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005876server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005877 Declare a server in a backend
5878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5879 no | no | yes | yes
5880 Arguments :
5881 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005882 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005883 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005884
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005885 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5886 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5887 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5888 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005889 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5890 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5891 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5892 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5893 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005894 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5895 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5896 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5897 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5898 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5899 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5900 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005901 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005902 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5903 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5904 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5905 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005906
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005907 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005908 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5909 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5910 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5911 adding this value to the client's port.
5912
5913 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5914 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005915 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005916
5917 Examples :
5918 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5919 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005920 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005921 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5922 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5923 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005924
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005925 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5926 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005927
5928
5929source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005930source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005931source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005932 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5934 yes | no | yes | yes
5935 Arguments :
5936 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5937 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005938
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005939 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005940 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5941 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5942 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5943 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5944 supported prefixes are :
5945 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5946 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5947 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005948 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005949 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5950 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5951 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5952 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005953
5954 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5955 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005956 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5957 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5958 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005959
5960 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5961 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5962 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5963 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5964 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5965 <addr>.
5966
5967 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5968 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5969 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5970 port.
5971
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005972 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5973 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5974 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5975 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005976 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005977 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5978 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5979 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5980 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5981 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5982 HTTP header.
5983
5984 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5985 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005986 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005987 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5988 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5989 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5990 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5991 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5992 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5993 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5994
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005995 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5996 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5997 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5998 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5999 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6000 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6001
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006002 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6003 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6004 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6005 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6006
6007 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6008 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6009 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6010 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6011 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6012 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6013
6014 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6015 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6016 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6017 there are two methods :
6018
6019 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6020 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6021 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6022 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6023 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6024 of the client ranges may be used.
6025
6026 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6027 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6028 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6029 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6030 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6031 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6032 same session.
6033
6034 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6035 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6036 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6037 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6038 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6039 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6040
6041 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6042 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6043 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006044 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006045
6046 Examples :
6047 backend private
6048 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6049 source 192.168.1.200
6050
6051 backend transparent_ssl1
6052 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6053 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6054
6055 backend transparent_ssl2
6056 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6057 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6058 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6059
6060 backend transparent_ssl3
6061 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6062 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6063 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6064
6065 backend transparent_smtp
6066 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6067 # with Tproxy version 4.
6068 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6069
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006070 backend transparent_http
6071 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6072 # proxy.
6073 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006075 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006076 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006078
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006079srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6080 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | no | yes | yes
6083 Arguments :
6084 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6086 as explained at the top of this document.
6087
6088 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6089 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6090 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6091 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6092 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6093 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6094 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6095
6096 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6097 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6098 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6099 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6100 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006101 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006102 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006103 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006104
6105 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6106 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6107 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6108 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6109 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6110 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6111
6112 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6113 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6114
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006115 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6116 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006117
6118
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006119stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6120 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006122 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006123
6124 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6125 matched.
6126
6127 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6128 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6129
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006130 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6131 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6132 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6133
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006134 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6135 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6136 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6137 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006138
6139 Example :
6140 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6141 backend stats_localhost
6142 stats enable
6143 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6144
6145 Example :
6146 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6147 backend stats_auth
6148 stats enable
6149 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6150 stats admin if TRUE
6151
6152 Example :
6153 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6154 userlist stats-auth
6155 group admin users admin
6156 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6157 group readonly users haproxy
6158 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6159
6160 backend stats_auth
6161 stats enable
6162 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6163 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6164 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6165 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6166
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006167 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6168 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6169 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006170
6171
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006172stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6173 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006175 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006176 Arguments :
6177 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6178
6179 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6180
6181 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6182 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6183 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6184 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6185 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6186 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6187
6188 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6189 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6190 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006191 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006192
6193 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6194 report using "stats scope".
6195
6196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6198 unobvious parameters.
6199
6200 Example :
6201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6202 backend public_www
6203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6204 stats enable
6205 stats hide-version
6206 stats scope .
6207 stats uri /admin?stats
6208 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6211
6212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6213 backend private_monitoring
6214 stats enable
6215 stats uri /admin?stats
6216 stats refresh 5s
6217
6218 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6219
6220
6221stats enable
6222 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006224 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006225 Arguments : none
6226
6227 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6228 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6229 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6230 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6231 - stats auth : no authentication
6232 - stats scope : no restriction
6233
6234 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6235 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6236 unobvious parameters.
6237
6238 Example :
6239 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6240 backend public_www
6241 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6242 stats enable
6243 stats hide-version
6244 stats scope .
6245 stats uri /admin?stats
6246 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6247 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6248 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6249
6250 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6251 backend private_monitoring
6252 stats enable
6253 stats uri /admin?stats
6254 stats refresh 5s
6255
6256 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6257
6258
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006259stats hide-version
6260 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006262 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006263 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006264
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006265 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6266 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6267 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6268 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6269 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6270 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006272 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6273 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6274 unobvious parameters.
6275
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006276 Example :
6277 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6278 backend public_www
6279 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006280 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006281 stats hide-version
6282 stats scope .
6283 stats uri /admin?stats
6284 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6285 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6286 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006287
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006288 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6289 backend private_monitoring
6290 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006291 stats uri /admin?stats
6292 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006293
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006294 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006295
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006296
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006297stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6298 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6299 Access control for statistics
6300
6301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6302 no | no | yes | yes
6303
6304 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6305 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6306 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6307 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6308 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6309 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6310
6311 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6312 instance.
6313
6314 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6315 about ACL usage.
6316
6317
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006318stats realm <realm>
6319 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006321 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006322 Arguments :
6323 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6324 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6325 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6326
6327 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6328 using a backslash ('\').
6329
6330 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6331 only related to authentication.
6332
6333 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6334 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6335 unobvious parameters.
6336
6337 Example :
6338 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6339 backend public_www
6340 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6341 stats enable
6342 stats hide-version
6343 stats scope .
6344 stats uri /admin?stats
6345 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6346 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6347 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6348
6349 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6350 backend private_monitoring
6351 stats enable
6352 stats uri /admin?stats
6353 stats refresh 5s
6354
6355 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6356
6357
6358stats refresh <delay>
6359 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006361 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006362 Arguments :
6363 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6364 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6365 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6366 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6367 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6368 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6369
6370 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6371 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6372 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6373 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6374
6375 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6376 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6377 unobvious parameters.
6378
6379 Example :
6380 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6381 backend public_www
6382 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6383 stats enable
6384 stats hide-version
6385 stats scope .
6386 stats uri /admin?stats
6387 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6388 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6389 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6390
6391 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6392 backend private_monitoring
6393 stats enable
6394 stats uri /admin?stats
6395 stats refresh 5s
6396
6397 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6398
6399
6400stats scope { <name> | "." }
6401 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006403 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006404 Arguments :
6405 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6406 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6407 section in which the statement appears.
6408
6409 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6410 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6411 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6412 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6413 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6414 exists.
6415
6416 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6417 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6418 unobvious parameters.
6419
6420 Example :
6421 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6422 backend public_www
6423 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6424 stats enable
6425 stats hide-version
6426 stats scope .
6427 stats uri /admin?stats
6428 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6429 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6430 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6431
6432 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6433 backend private_monitoring
6434 stats enable
6435 stats uri /admin?stats
6436 stats refresh 5s
6437
6438 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6439
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006440
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006441stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006442 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006444 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006445
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006446 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006447 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6448
6449 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6450 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6451
6452 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6453 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006454 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006455
6456 Example :
6457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6458 backend private_monitoring
6459 stats enable
6460 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6461 stats uri /admin?stats
6462 stats refresh 5s
6463
6464 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6465 global section.
6466
6467
6468stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006469 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6471 yes | yes | yes | yes
6472 Arguments : none
6473
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006474 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006475 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6476 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6477 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6478 - IP (socket, server)
6479 - cookie (backend, server)
6480
6481 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6482 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006483 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006484
6485 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6486
6487
6488stats show-node [ <name> ]
6489 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006491 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006492 Arguments:
6493 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6494 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6495
6496 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6497 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006498 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006499
6500 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6501 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6502 unobvious parameters.
6503
6504 Example:
6505 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6506 backend private_monitoring
6507 stats enable
6508 stats show-node Europe-1
6509 stats uri /admin?stats
6510 stats refresh 5s
6511
6512 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6513 section.
6514
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006515
6516stats uri <prefix>
6517 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006519 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006520 Arguments :
6521 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6522 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6523 query string.
6524
6525 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6526 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6527 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6528 possible to reach it in the application.
6529
6530 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006531 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006532 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6533 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6534 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6535 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6536
6537 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6538 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6539 an address or a port to statistics only.
6540
6541 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6542 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6543 unobvious parameters.
6544
6545 Example :
6546 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6547 backend public_www
6548 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6549 stats enable
6550 stats hide-version
6551 stats scope .
6552 stats uri /admin?stats
6553 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6554 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6555 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6556
6557 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6558 backend private_monitoring
6559 stats enable
6560 stats uri /admin?stats
6561 stats refresh 5s
6562
6563 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6564
6565
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006566stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6567 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006569 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006570
6571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006572 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006573 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6574 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6575 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6576
6577 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6578 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6579 the "stick-table" statement.
6580
6581 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6582 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6583 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6584 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6585 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6586
6587 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6588 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6589 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6590 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6591 transformation rules.
6592
6593 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6594 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6595 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6596 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6597 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6598 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6599 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6600
6601 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6602 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6603 ACL based conditions.
6604
6605 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6606 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6607 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6608 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6609
6610 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6611 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6612 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6613 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6614
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006615 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6616 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6617 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6618
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006619 Example :
6620 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6621 # last 30 minutes
6622 backend pop
6623 mode tcp
6624 balance roundrobin
6625 stick store-request src
6626 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6627 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6628 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6629
6630 backend smtp
6631 mode tcp
6632 balance roundrobin
6633 stick match src table pop
6634 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6635 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6636
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006637 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006638 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006639
6640
6641stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6642 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6644 no | no | yes | yes
6645
6646 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6647 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6648 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6649 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6650
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006651 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6652 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6653 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6654
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006655 Examples :
6656 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006657 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006658
6659 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6660 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6661 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6662
6663
6664 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6665 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6666 backend http
6667 mode http
6668 balance roundrobin
6669 stick on src table https
6670 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6671 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6672 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6673
6674 backend https
6675 mode tcp
6676 balance roundrobin
6677 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6678 stick on src
6679 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6680 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6681
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006682 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006683
6684
6685stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6686 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6688 no | no | yes | yes
6689
6690 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006691 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006692 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6693 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6694 server is selected.
6695
6696 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6697 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6698 the "stick-table" statement.
6699
6700 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6701 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6702 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6703 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6704 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6705 address.
6706
6707 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6708 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6709 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6710 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6711 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6712 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6713 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6714 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6715 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6716 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6717
6718 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6719 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6720 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6721 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6722 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6723 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6724 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6725
6726 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6727 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6728 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6729 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6730
6731 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6732 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6733 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6734 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6735 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6736 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006737 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6738 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6739 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6740 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6741 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6742 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006743
6744 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6745 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6746 the request.
6747
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006748 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6749 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6750 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6751
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006752 Example :
6753 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6754 # last 30 minutes
6755 backend pop
6756 mode tcp
6757 balance roundrobin
6758 stick store-request src
6759 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6760 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6761 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6762
6763 backend smtp
6764 mode tcp
6765 balance roundrobin
6766 stick match src table pop
6767 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6768 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6769
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006770 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006771 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006772
6773
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006774stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006775 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6776 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006777 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006779 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006780
6781 Arguments :
6782 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6783 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6784 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6785 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6786
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006787 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6788 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6789 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6790 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6791
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006792 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6793 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6794 instance.
6795
6796 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6797 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6798 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6799 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6800 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6801 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006802 to 32 characters.
6803
6804 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6805 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6806 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006807 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006808 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6809 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006810
6811 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006812 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6813 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006814 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6815 increase.
6816
6817 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006818 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6819 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6820 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006821
6822 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6823 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6824 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6825 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6826 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6827 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6828 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6829 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6830 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6831 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6832 parameter (see below).
6833
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006834 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6835 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6836 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6837 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6838 soft restart.
6839
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006840 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6841
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006842 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6843 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6844 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6845 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6846 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006847 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006848 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6849 if not expiration delay is specified.
6850
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006851 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6852 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6853 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6854 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006855 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6856 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6857 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6858 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6859 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6860 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6861 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6862 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6863 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6864 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6865 types and their arguments.
6866
6867 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6868 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6869 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6870 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6871
6872 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6873 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6874 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6875 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6876
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006877 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6878 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6879 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6880 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6881 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6882 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6883
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006884 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6885 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6886 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6887 they were received.
6888
6889 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6890 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6891 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6892 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6893 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6894
6895 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6896 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6897 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6898 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6899 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6900
6901 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6902 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6903 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6904
6905 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6906 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6907 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6908 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6909 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6910
6911 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6912 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6913 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6914 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6915 the client side.
6916
6917 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6918 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6919 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6920 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6921 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6922 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6923 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6924
6925 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6926 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6927 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6928 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6929 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6930 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6931 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6932
6933 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6934 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6935 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6936 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6937 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6938 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6939
6940 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6941 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6942 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6943 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6944
6945 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6946 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6947 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6948 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6949 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6950 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6951 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6952 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6953 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6954 recommended for better fairness.
6955
6956 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6957 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6958 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6959 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6960
6961 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6962 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6963 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6964 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6965 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6966 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6967 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6968 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6969 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6970 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006971
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006972 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6973 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006974 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6975 reference it.
6976
6977 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6978 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6979 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6980 as an exclusive stickiness.
6981
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006982 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6983 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6984 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6985 something that can be ignored.
6986
6987 Example:
6988 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6989 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6990 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6991 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6992
6993 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006994 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006995
6996
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006997stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6998 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7000 no | no | yes | yes
7001
7002 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007003 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007004 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7005 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7006 server is selected.
7007
7008 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7009 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7010 the "stick-table" statement.
7011
7012 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7013 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7014 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7015 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7016
7017 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7018 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7019 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7020 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7021 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7022 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007023 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007024 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7025 rules.
7026
7027 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7028 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7029 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7030 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7031 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7032 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7033 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7034
7035 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7036 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7037 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7038 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7039
7040 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7041 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7042 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7043 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7044 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7045 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007046 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7047 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7048 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7049 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7050 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7051 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7052 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7053 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7054 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007055
7056 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7057
7058 Example :
7059 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7060 backend https
7061 mode tcp
7062 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007063 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007064 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007065
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007066 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7067 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7068
7069 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7070 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7071 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7072
7073 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7074 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007075
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007076 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7077 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7078 # at offset 44.
7079
7080 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7081 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7082
7083 # Learn on response if server hello.
7084 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007085
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007086 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7087 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7088
7089 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7090 extraction.
7091
7092
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007093tcp-check connect [params*]
7094 Opens a new connection
7095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 no | no | yes | yes
7097
7098 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7099 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7100 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7101
7102 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7103 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7104 of the sequence.
7105
7106 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7107 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7108 do.
7109
7110 Parameters :
7111 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7112 use the TCP connection.
7113
7114 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7115 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7116 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7117
7118 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7119
7120 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7121
7122 Examples:
7123 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7124 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7125 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7126 option tcp-check
7127 tcp-check connect
7128 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7129 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7130 tcp-check send \r\n
7131 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7132 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7133 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7134 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7135 tcp-check send \r\n
7136 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7137 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7138
7139 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7140 option tcp-check
7141 tcp-check connect port 110
7142 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7143 tcp-check connect port 143
7144 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7145 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7146
7147 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7148
7149
7150tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7151 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 no | no | yes | yes
7154
7155 Arguments :
7156 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7157 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7158 binary.
7159 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7160 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7161 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7162
7163 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7164 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7165 with the usual backslash ('\').
7166 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7167 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7168 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7169 used upper or lower case.
7170
7171
7172 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7173
7174 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7175 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7176 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7177 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7178 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7179 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7180 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7181 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7182
7183 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7184 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7185 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7186 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7187 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7188 expression.
7189
7190 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7191 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7192 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7193 this exact hexadecimal string.
7194 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7195
7196 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7197 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7198 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7199 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7200 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7201 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7202 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7203 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7204 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7205 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7206 the null character.
7207
7208 Examples :
7209 # perform a POP check
7210 option tcp-check
7211 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7212
7213 # perform an IMAP check
7214 option tcp-check
7215 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7216
7217 # look for the redis master server
7218 option tcp-check
7219 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7220 tcp-check expect +PONG
7221 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7222 tcp-check expect string role:master
7223 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7224 tcp-check expect string +OK
7225
7226
7227 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7228 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7229
7230
7231tcp-check send <data>
7232 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 no | no | yes | yes
7235
7236 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7237 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7238
7239 Examples :
7240 # look for the redis master server
7241 option tcp-check
7242 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7243 tcp-check expect string role:master
7244
7245 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7246 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7247
7248
7249tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7250 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7251 tcp health check
7252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 no | no | yes | yes
7254
7255 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7256 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7257 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7258 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7259 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7260 hexadecimal string.
7261 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7262
7263 Examples :
7264 # redis check in binary
7265 option tcp-check
7266 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7267 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7268
7269
7270 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7271 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7272
7273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007274tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7275 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007278 Arguments :
7279 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007280 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7281 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007283 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007284
7285 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7286 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007287 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7288 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7289 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7290 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7291 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7292 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007294 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7295 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7296 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7297 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007298
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007299 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007300 - accept :
7301 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7302 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7303 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007305 - reject :
7306 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7307 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7308 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7309 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7310 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7311 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7312 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7313 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7314 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7315 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7316 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7317 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007318
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007319 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7320 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7321 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7322 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7323 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7324 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7325 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7326 hosts.
7327
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007328 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7329 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7330 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7331 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7332 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7333 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7334 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7335 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7336 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7337 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7338 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7339
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007340 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007341 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7342 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7343 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007344 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7345 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007346 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007347 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7348 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7349 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7350 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7351 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007352
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007354 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007355 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007356 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7357 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7358 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7359 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007361 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7362 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7363 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7364 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007366 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7367 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7368 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7369 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7370 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007371 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7372 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7373 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7374 layer7 information is extracted.
7375
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007376 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7377 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7378 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7379 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7380 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007381
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007382 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7383 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7384 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007385
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007386 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7387 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7388 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007390 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007391 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007392 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007394 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7395 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7396 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007398 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007399 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7400 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007401
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007402 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7403
7404 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7405
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007406 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007408 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
7410
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007411tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7412 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007414 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007415 Arguments :
7416 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007417 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007418 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7419 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007421 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007422
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007423 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7424 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7425 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7426 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7427 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007428
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007429 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7430 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7431 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7432 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007433 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7434 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7435 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7436 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7437 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7438 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007439 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007440 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007442 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7443 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7444 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7445 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007446
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007447 Four types of actions are supported :
7448 - accept : the request is accepted
7449 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7450 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007451 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007453 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7454 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007455
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007456 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7457 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7458 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7459 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7460 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7461 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007463 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007464 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7465 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007467 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007468 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7469 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7470 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7471 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007472 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7473 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7474 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007475
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007476 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007477 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7478 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7479 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007480
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007481 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007482 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7483 # and reject everything else.
7484 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7485 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007486 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 tcp-request content reject
7488
7489 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007490 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7491 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7492 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007493 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007494
7495 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7496 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7497 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007498 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007499 tcp-request content reject
7500
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007501 Example:
7502 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7503 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007504 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007505
7506 Example:
7507 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7508 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007509 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007511 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7512 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7513
7514 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007515 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007516 # protecting all our sites
7517 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007518 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7519 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007520 ...
7521 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7522
7523 backend http_dynamic
7524 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007525 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007526 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007527 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7528 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7529 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007530 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007532 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007534 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007535
7536
7537tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7538 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007540 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007541 Arguments :
7542 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7543 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7544 as explained at the top of this document.
7545
7546 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7547 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7548 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7549 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7550 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7551
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007552 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7553 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7554 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7555 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7556
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007557 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7558 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007559 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007560 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007561 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7562 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7563 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7564 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007565
7566 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7567 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7568 it pass through unaffected.
7569
7570 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7571 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7572 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007573 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007574 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7575 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007576 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7577 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7578 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007579
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007580 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007581 "timeout client".
7582
7583
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007584tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7585 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7587 no | no | yes | yes
7588 Arguments :
7589 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007590 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007591
7592 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7593
7594 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7595 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7596 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007597 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7598 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007599
7600 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7601
7602 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7603 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7604 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7605 inserted.
7606
7607 Two types of actions are supported :
7608 - accept :
7609 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7610 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7611 the rules evaluation.
7612
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007613 - close :
7614 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7615 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7616 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7617 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7618 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7619 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007620 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007621 protocols.
7622
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007623 - reject :
7624 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7625 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007626 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007627
7628 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7629 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7630 for changing the default action to a reject.
7631
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007632 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7633 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7634 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7635 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007636 period.
7637
7638 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7639
7640 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7641
7642
7643tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7644 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7646 no | no | yes | yes
7647 Arguments :
7648 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7649 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7650 as explained at the top of this document.
7651
7652 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7653
7654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007655timeout check <timeout>
7656 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7657 established.
7658
7659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7660 yes | no | yes | yes
7661 Arguments:
7662 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7663 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7664 as explained at the top of this document.
7665
7666 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7667 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7668 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7669 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007670 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7671 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7672 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007673
7674 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7675 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7676
7677 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7678 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007679 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007680
7681 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7682 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7683 forget about it.
7684
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007685 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7686 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007687
7688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007689timeout client <timeout>
7690timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7691 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7693 yes | yes | yes | no
7694 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007695 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007696 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7697 as explained at the top of this document.
7698
7699 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7700 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7701 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7702 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7703 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7704 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7705 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7706 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007707 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007708 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007709 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7710 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007711 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7712 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007713
7714 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7715 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7716 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7717 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7718 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7719 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7720
7721 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7722 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7723 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7724
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007725 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007726
7727
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007728timeout client-fin <timeout>
7729 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 yes | yes | yes | no
7732 Arguments :
7733 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7734 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7735 as explained at the top of this document.
7736
7737 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7738 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7739 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7740 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7741 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7742 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7743 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7744 down in one direction.
7745
7746 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7747 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7748 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7749
7750 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7751
7752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007753timeout connect <timeout>
7754timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7755 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7757 yes | no | yes | yes
7758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007759 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007760 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7761 as explained at the top of this document.
7762
7763 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007764 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007765 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007766 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007767 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7768 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007769
7770 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7771 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7772 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7773 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7774 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7775 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7776
7777 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7778 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7779 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7780
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007781 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7782 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007783
7784
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007785timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7786 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7788 yes | yes | yes | yes
7789 Arguments :
7790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7792 as explained at the top of this document.
7793
7794 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7795 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7796 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7797 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7798 once the request has started to present itself.
7799
7800 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7801 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7802 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7803 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7804 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7805
7806 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7807 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7808 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7809 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7810
7811 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7812 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7813 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7814 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7815 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007816 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007817
7818 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7819 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7820 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7821 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7822
7823 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7824
7825
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007826timeout http-request <timeout>
7827 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007829 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7833 as explained at the top of this document.
7834
7835 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7836 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7837 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7838 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7839 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7840 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7841 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007842 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7843 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7844 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7845 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7846 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7847 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7848 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007849
7850 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7851 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007852 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7853 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007854
7855 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7856 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7857 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7858 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7859 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7860
7861 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007862 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7863 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7864 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007865
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007866 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007867
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007868
7869timeout queue <timeout>
7870 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7872 yes | no | yes | yes
7873 Arguments :
7874 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7875 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7876 as explained at the top of this document.
7877
7878 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7879 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7880 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7881 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7882 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7883
7884 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7885 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7886 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7887 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7888
7889 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7890
7891
7892timeout server <timeout>
7893timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7894 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | no | yes | yes
7897 Arguments :
7898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7900 as explained at the top of this document.
7901
7902 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7903 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7904 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7905 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7906 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7907 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7908 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7909
7910 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7911 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7912 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7913 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7914 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007915 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007916 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007917 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7918 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7919 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7920 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007921
7922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7923 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7924 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7925 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7926 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7927 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7928
7929 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7930 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7931 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7932
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007933 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007934
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007935
7936timeout server-fin <timeout>
7937 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 yes | no | yes | yes
7940 Arguments :
7941 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7942 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7943 as explained at the top of this document.
7944
7945 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7946 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7947 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7948 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7949 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7950 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7951 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7952 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7953 situations, it should not be needed.
7954
7955 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7956 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7957 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7958
7959 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7960
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007961
7962timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007963 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7965 yes | yes | yes | yes
7966 Arguments :
7967 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7968 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7969 as explained at the top of this document.
7970
7971 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7972 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7973 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7974
7975 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7976 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7977 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7978 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007979 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007980
7981 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7982
7983
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007984timeout tunnel <timeout>
7985 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7987 yes | no | yes | yes
7988 Arguments :
7989 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7990 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7991 as explained at the top of this document.
7992
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007993 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007994 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7995 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7996 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7997 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7998 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7999 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8000 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8001 specified.
8002
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008003 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8004 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8005 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8006 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8007 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8008 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8009 state.
8010
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008011 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8012 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8013 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8014 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8015 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8016
8017 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8018 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8019 forget about it.
8020
8021 Example :
8022 defaults http
8023 option http-server-close
8024 timeout connect 5s
8025 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008026 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008027 timeout server 30s
8028 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8029
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008030 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008031
8032
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008033transparent (deprecated)
8034 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008036 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008037 Arguments : none
8038
8039 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8040 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8041 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8042 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8043 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8044 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8045 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8046 appropriate server.
8047
8048 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8049
8050 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8051 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8052
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008053 See also: "option transparent"
8054
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008055unique-id-format <string>
8056 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8058 yes | yes | yes | no
8059 Arguments :
8060 <string> is a log-format string.
8061
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008062 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8063 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8064 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8065 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008066
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008067 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8068 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8069 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8070 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8071 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8072 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8073 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8074 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008075
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008076 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8077 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008078
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008079 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008080
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008081 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008082
8083 will generate:
8084
8085 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8086
8087 See also: "unique-id-header"
8088
8089unique-id-header <name>
8090 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8092 yes | yes | yes | no
8093 Arguments :
8094 <name> is the name of the header.
8095
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008096 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8097 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008098
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008099 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008100
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008101 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008102 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8103
8104 will generate:
8105
8106 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8107
8108 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008109
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008110use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008111 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8113 no | yes | yes | no
8114 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008115 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8116 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008117
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008118 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8119 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008120
8121 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8122 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8123 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008124 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8125 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8126 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8127 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008128
8129 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8130 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8131 assign the backend.
8132
8133 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8134 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8135 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8136 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8137 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8138 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8139
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008140 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008141 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008142 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8143 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8144 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8145
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008146 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8147 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8148 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8149 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8150 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8151 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8152 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8153 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8154 cannot be forced from the request.
8155
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008156 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008157 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8158 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8159
8160 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8161 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008162
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008163
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008164use-server <server> if <condition>
8165use-server <server> unless <condition>
8166 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8168 no | no | yes | yes
8169 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008170 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008171
8172 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8173
8174 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8175 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8176 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8177
8178 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8179 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8180 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8181 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8182 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8183 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8184 matches will assign the server.
8185
8186 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8187 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8188 with the next rules until one matches.
8189
8190 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8191 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8192 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8193 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8194
8195 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8196 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8197 stripped.
8198
8199 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8200 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8201 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8202 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8203
8204 Example :
8205 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8206 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8207 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8208 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8209 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8210 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8211 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8212 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8213 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8214
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008215 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008216
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008217
82185. Bind and Server options
8219--------------------------
8220
8221The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8222depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8223settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8224written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8225described in this section.
8226
8227
82285.1. Bind options
8229-----------------
8230
8231The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8232as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8233no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8234parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8235while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8236provided immediately after the setting name.
8237
8238The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8239
8240accept-proxy
8241 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008242 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8243 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008244 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8245 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8246 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8247 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8248 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8249 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8250 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008251 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8252 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008253
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008254alpn <protocols>
8255 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8256 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8257 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8258 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8259 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8260 initial NPN extension.
8261
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008262backlog <backlog>
8263 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8264 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8265
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008266ecdhe <named curve>
8267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008268 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8269 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008270
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008271ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8273 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8274 client's certificate.
8275
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008276ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8278 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8279 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8280 error is ignored.
8281
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008282ciphers <ciphers>
8283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8284 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008285 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008286 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8287 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8288
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008289crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8291 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8292 to verify client's certificate.
8293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008294crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8296 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8297 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8298 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8299 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8300 file.
8301
8302 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8303 are loaded.
8304
8305 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008306 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8307 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008308 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8309 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8310 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8311 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8312 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8313 www.sub.example.org).
8314
8315 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8316 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8317 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8318 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8319 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8320
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008321 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008322
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008323 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8324 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008325 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008326 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8327 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8328 clients).
8329
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008330 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8331 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8332 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8333 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8334 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8335 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8336 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8337 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8338 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8339 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8340 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8341 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8342 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8343
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008344crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8346 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008347 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008348 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008349
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008350crt-list <file>
8351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008352 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8353 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008354
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008355 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008356
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008357 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8358 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8359 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8360 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8361 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8362 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8363 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8364 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008365
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008366defer-accept
8367 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8368 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8369 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8370 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8371 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8372 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8373 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8374 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8375 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8376 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8377 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8378
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008379force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008380 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008381 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8382 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8383
8384force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008385 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008386 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8387
8388force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008389 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008390 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8391
8392force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008393 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008394 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008396gid <gid>
8397 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8398 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8399 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8400 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8401 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8402
8403group <group>
8404 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8405 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8406 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8407 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8408 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8409
8410id <id>
8411 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8412 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8413 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8414 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8415
8416interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008417 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8418 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8419 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8420 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8421 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8422 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8423 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008424
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008425level <level>
8426 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8427 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8428 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8429 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8430 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8431 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8432 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8433 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8434 counters).
8435 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8436 all counters).
8437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008438maxconn <maxconn>
8439 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8440 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8441 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8442 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8443 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8444 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8445 eat all memory.
8446
8447mode <mode>
8448 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8449 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8450 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8451 UNIX sockets.
8452
8453mss <maxseg>
8454 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8455 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8456 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8457 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8458 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8459 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8460 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8461 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8462 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8463 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8464 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8465
8466name <name>
8467 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8468 page.
8469
8470nice <nice>
8471 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8472 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8473 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8474 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8475 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8476 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8477 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8478 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8479 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8480 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8481 one for an RDP socket.
8482
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008483no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008485 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008486 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008487 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8488 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008489
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008490no-tls-tickets
8491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8492 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8493 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8494 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8495
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008496no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008498 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008499 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8500 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8501 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008502
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008503no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008505 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008506 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8507 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8508 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008509
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008510no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008512 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008513 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8514 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8515 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008516
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008517npn <protocols>
8518 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8519 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8520 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8521 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008522 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8523 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008524
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008525process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8526 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8527 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8528 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8529 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8530 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8531 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8532 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008533 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8534 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8535 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8536 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8537 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8538 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8539 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008540
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008541ssl
8542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008543 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008544 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8545 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8546 to deciphered contents.
8547
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008548strict-sni
8549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8550 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8551 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8552 See the "crt" option for more information.
8553
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008554tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008555 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008556 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8557 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8558 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8559 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8560 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8561 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8562 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008563 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8564 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8565 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008566
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008567transparent
8568 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8569 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8570 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8571 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8572 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8573 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8574 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8575 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8576 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8577 so check for support with your vendor.
8578
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008579v4v6
8580 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8581 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8582 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8583 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008584 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008585
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008586v6only
8587 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8588 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8589 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008590 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8591 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008592
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008593uid <uid>
8594 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8595 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8596 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8597 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8598 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8599
8600user <user>
8601 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8602 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8603 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8604 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8605 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8606
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008607verify [none|optional|required]
8608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8609 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8610 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8611 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8612 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008613 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8614 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8615 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8616 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086185.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008619------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008621The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8622which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8623arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8624settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8625after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8626Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8627address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008629 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008630 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008632The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008633
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008634addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008635 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8636 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8637 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8638 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8639 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008641 Supported in default-server: No
8642
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008643agent-check
8644 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008645 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8646 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8647 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8648 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008649
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008650 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008651 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008652 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8653 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8654 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008655
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008656 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8657 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008658
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008659 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8660 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8661 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008662
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008663 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8664 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8665 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008666
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008667 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8668 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8669 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8670 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8671 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8672 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8673 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008674
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008675 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8676 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008677
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008678 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8679 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8680 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8681 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8682 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8683 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8684 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8685 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8686 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008687
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008688 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8689 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008690 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8691 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8692 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8693 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008694
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008695 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8696 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008697
8698 Supported in default-server: No
8699
8700agent-inter <delay>
8701 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8702 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8703
8704 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8705 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8706 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8707 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8708 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8709 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8710 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8711 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8712 of backends use the same servers.
8713
8714 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8715
8716 Supported in default-server: Yes
8717
8718agent-port <port>
8719 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8720
8721 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8722
8723 Supported in default-server: Yes
8724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008725backup
8726 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8727 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8728 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8729 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8730 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8731 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008733 Supported in default-server: No
8734
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008735ca-file <cafile>
8736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8737 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8738 server's certificate.
8739
8740 Supported in default-server: No
8741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008742check
8743 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008744 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8745 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8746 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8747 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8748 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8749 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8750 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008751 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8752 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8753 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008755 Supported in default-server: No
8756
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008757check-send-proxy
8758 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8759 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8760 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8761 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8762 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8763 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8764 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8765
8766 Supported in default-server: No
8767
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008768check-ssl
8769 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8770 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8771 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8772 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008773 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008774 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8775 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8776 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8777 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8778
8779 Supported in default-server: No
8780
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008781ciphers <ciphers>
8782 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008783 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008784 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8785 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8786 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8787 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8788 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8789 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8790
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008791 Supported in default-server: No
8792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008793cookie <value>
8794 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8795 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8796 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8797 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8798 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8799 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8800 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008802 Supported in default-server: No
8803
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008804crl-file <crlfile>
8805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8806 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8807 to verify server's certificate.
8808
8809 Supported in default-server: No
8810
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008811crt <cert>
8812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8813 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8814 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8815 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8816 certificate request.
8817
8818 Supported in default-server: No
8819
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008820disabled
8821 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8822 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8823 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8824 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8825 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8826
8827 Supported in default-server: No
8828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008829error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008830 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8831 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8832 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008834 Supported in default-server: Yes
8835
8836 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008838fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008839 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8840 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8841 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008843 Supported in default-server: Yes
8844
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008845force-sslv3
8846 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8847 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8848 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8849
8850 Supported in default-server: No
8851
8852force-tlsv10
8853 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8854 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8855
8856 Supported in default-server: No
8857
8858force-tlsv11
8859 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8860 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8861
8862 Supported in default-server: No
8863
8864force-tlsv12
8865 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8866 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8867
8868 Supported in default-server: No
8869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008870id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008871 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8872 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8873 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008875 Supported in default-server: No
8876
8877inter <delay>
8878fastinter <delay>
8879downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008880 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8881 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8882 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8883 between checks depending on the server state :
8884
8885 Server state | Interval used
8886 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8887 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8888 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8889 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8890 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8891 or yet unchecked. |
8892 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8893 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8894 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008896 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8897 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8898 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8899 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008900 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8901 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8902 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8903 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8904 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008906 Supported in default-server: Yes
8907
8908maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008909 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8910 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8911 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8912 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8913 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8914 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8915 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8916 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008918 Supported in default-server: Yes
8919
8920maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008921 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8922 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8923 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8924 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8925 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8926 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8927 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008929 Supported in default-server: Yes
8930
8931minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008932 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8933 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8934 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8935 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8936 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8937 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008938 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008939 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008941 Supported in default-server: Yes
8942
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008943no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008944 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8945 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008946 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008947
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008948 Supported in default-server: No
8949
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008950no-tls-tickets
8951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8952 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8953 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8954 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8955
8956 Supported in default-server: No
8957
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008958no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008959 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008960 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8961 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008962 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8963 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008964
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008965 Supported in default-server: No
8966
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008967no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008968 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008969 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8970 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008971 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8972 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008973
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008974 Supported in default-server: No
8975
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008976no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008977 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008978 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8979 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008980 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8981 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008982
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008983 Supported in default-server: No
8984
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008985non-stick
8986 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8987 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8988 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8989
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008990 Supported in default-server: No
8991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008992observe <mode>
8993 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8994 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8995 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8996 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8997 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8998 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008999 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009001 Supported in default-server: No
9002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009003 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009005on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009006 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9007 Currently, four modes are available:
9008 - fastinter: force fastinter
9009 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9010 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9011 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9012 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009014 Supported in default-server: Yes
9015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009016 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9017
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009018on-marked-down <action>
9019 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9020 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009021 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9022 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9023 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9024 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9025 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9026 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9027 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9028 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009029
9030 Actions are disabled by default
9031
9032 Supported in default-server: Yes
9033
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009034on-marked-up <action>
9035 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9036 Currently one action is available:
9037 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9038 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9039 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9040 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9041 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9042 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9043 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9044 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9045
9046 Actions are disabled by default
9047
9048 Supported in default-server: Yes
9049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009050port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009051 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9052 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9053 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9054 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9055 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9056 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009058 Supported in default-server: Yes
9059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009060redir <prefix>
9061 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9062 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9063 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9064 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9065 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9066 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9067 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9068 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009069 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009070 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9071 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9072 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9073 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9074 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9075
9076 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009078 Supported in default-server: No
9079
9080rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009081 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9082 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9083 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009085 Supported in default-server: Yes
9086
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009087send-proxy
9088 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9089 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9090 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9091 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9092 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9093 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9094 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9095 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9096 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009097 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9098 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9099 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9100 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9101 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009102
9103 Supported in default-server: No
9104
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009105send-proxy-v2
9106 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9107 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9108 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9109 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9110 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9111 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9112 option of the "bind" keyword.
9113
9114 Supported in default-server: No
9115
9116send-proxy-v2-ssl
9117 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9118 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9119 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9120 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9121 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9122 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9123 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9124 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9125
9126 Supported in default-server: No
9127
9128send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9129 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9130 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9131 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9132 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9133 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9134 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9135 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9136 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9137 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9138
9139 Supported in default-server: No
9140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009141slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009142 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9143 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9144 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9145 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9146 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9147 parameters :
9148
9149 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9150 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9151
9152 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9153 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9154 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9155 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9156
9157 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9158 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9159 seen as failed.
9160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009161 Supported in default-server: Yes
9162
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009163source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009164source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009165source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009166 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9167 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9168 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9169 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9170
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009171 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9172 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9173 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9174 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9175 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9176 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9177 server.
9178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009179 Supported in default-server: No
9180
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009181ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009182 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9183 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9184 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9185 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9186 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9187 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009188 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009189
9190 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009192track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009193 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9194 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9195 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9196 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009197 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009199 Supported in default-server: No
9200
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009201verify [none|required]
9202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009203 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9204 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9205 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9206 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009207 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9208 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9209 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009210
9211 Supported in default-server: No
9212
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009213verifyhost <hostname>
9214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9215 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9216 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9217 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9218 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9219 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9220
9221 Supported in default-server: No
9222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009223weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009224 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9225 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9226 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009227 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9228 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9229 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9230 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9231 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9232 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009233
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009234 Supported in default-server: Yes
9235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009236
92376. HTTP header manipulation
9238---------------------------
9239
9240In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9241response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9242request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9243which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009244against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009245
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009246If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9247to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9248but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9249HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9250stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9251because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9252a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9253still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009255This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9256in section 4.2 :
9257
9258 - reqadd <string>
9259 - reqallow <search>
9260 - reqiallow <search>
9261 - reqdel <search>
9262 - reqidel <search>
9263 - reqdeny <search>
9264 - reqideny <search>
9265 - reqpass <search>
9266 - reqipass <search>
9267 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9268 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9269 - reqtarpit <search>
9270 - reqitarpit <search>
9271 - rspadd <string>
9272 - rspdel <search>
9273 - rspidel <search>
9274 - rspdeny <search>
9275 - rspideny <search>
9276 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9277 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9278
9279With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9280is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9281parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9282prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9283Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9284
9285 \t for a tab
9286 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9287 \n for a new line (LF)
9288 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9289 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9290 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9291 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9292 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9293
9294The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9295portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9296above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9297regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
92989 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9299is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9300
9301The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9302after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9303
9304Notes related to these keywords :
9305---------------------------------
9306 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9307 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9308 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9309
9310 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9311 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9312 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9313
9314 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9315 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9316 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9317 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9318 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9319
9320 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9321 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9322 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9323 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9324 useless headers before adding new ones.
9325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009326 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009327 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9328
9329 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9330 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9331 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9332
9333 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9334 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009335 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009336
9337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093387. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9339----------------------------------
9340
9341Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9342client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9343The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9344these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9345but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9346data called patterns.
9347
9348
93497.1. ACL basics
9350---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009351
9352The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9353content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9354from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9355simple :
9356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009357 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009358 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009359 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9360 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009362The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9363adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009364
9365In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009368
9369This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9370Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9371and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009372an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9373conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9374as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9375are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009376
9377ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9378'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9379which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9380
9381There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9382performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009384The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9385specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9386this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009387methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9388ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009389
9390Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9391 - boolean
9392 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9393 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9394 - string
9395 - data block
9396
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009397Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9398converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9399would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9400The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9401which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9402
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009403Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9404keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9405fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9406which are summarized in the table below :
9407
9408 +---------------------+-----------------+
9409 | Sample or converter | Default |
9410 | output type | matching method |
9411 +---------------------+-----------------+
9412 | boolean | bool |
9413 +---------------------+-----------------+
9414 | integer | int |
9415 +---------------------+-----------------+
9416 | ip | ip |
9417 +---------------------+-----------------+
9418 | string | str |
9419 +---------------------+-----------------+
9420 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9421 +---------------------+-----------------+
9422
9423Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9424matching method, see below.
9425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9427 - boolean
9428 - integer or integer range
9429 - IP address / network
9430 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9431 - regular expression
9432 - hex block
9433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009434The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9435
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009436 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9437 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009438 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009439 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009440 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009441 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009442 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009444The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9445read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9446if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9447lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9448will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9449beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9450a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9451lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9452exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9453
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009454The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9455parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9456ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9457a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9458check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9459
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009460The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9461socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9462file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009464Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9465loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9466
9467 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9468
9469In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9470the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9471case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9472as well.
9473
9474The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9475sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9476do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9477methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9478is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9479obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9480followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9481default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9482that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9483string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9484
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009485The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9486By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9487string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9488resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9489server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9490waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9491flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9492function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009494There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9495sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9496be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009497
9498 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9499 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9501 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9502 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9503 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009504
9505 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9506 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009507 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009508
9509 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009510 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009511
9512 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009513 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009514
9515 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9516 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9517
9518 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9519 binary or string samples.
9520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009521 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9522 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009524 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9525 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9526 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9529 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9532 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009534 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9535 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009537 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9538 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009539 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009541 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9542 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9543 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009544
9545For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9546request, it is possible to do :
9547
9548 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9549
9550In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9551buffer, one would use the following acl :
9552
9553 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9554
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009555On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9556possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9557
9558 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009560All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9561criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9562method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9563to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9564criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9565the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009567If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009568the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9569For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9572 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9573 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9574 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009575
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009576
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009577The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9578types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9579combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9580brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9581default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 +-------------------------------------------------+
9584 | Input sample type |
9585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009586 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9588 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009590 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009592 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009594 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009596 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009598 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009600 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009601 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009602 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009604 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009606 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009607 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009608 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009610 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009611 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9612 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9613 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009614
9615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096167.1.1. Matching booleans
9617------------------------
9618
9619In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9620Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9621When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9622that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9623
9624Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9625return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9626"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096297.1.2. Matching integers
9630------------------------
9631
9632Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9633enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9634to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9635
9636Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9637matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9638lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009639
9640For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9641unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9642representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9643
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009644As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9645two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9646instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9647ranges and operators.
9648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009649For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009650operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9651Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9652of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009654Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009655
9656 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9657 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9658 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9659 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9660 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9661
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009662For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009663
9664 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9665
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009666This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9667
9668 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096717.1.3. Matching strings
9672-----------------------
9673
9674String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9675different forms :
9676
9677 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9678 patterns ;
9679
9680 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9681 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9682
9683 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9684 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9685
9686 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9687 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9688
9689 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9690 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9691 matches.
9692
9693 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9694 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9695 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009696
9697String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9698exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9699characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9700string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9701to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009702before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009703
9704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097057.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9706---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009707
9708Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9709they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9710possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9711passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9712the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009713the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9714match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009715
9716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097177.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9718-------------------------------------
9719
9720It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9721not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9722a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9723to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9724digits may be used upper or lower case.
9725
9726Example :
9727 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9728 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9729
9730
97317.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9732---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009733
9734IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9735netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9736within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009737host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009738difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9739at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9740does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9741parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009742
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009743IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9744Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9745trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9746IPv6 patterns.
9747
9748HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9749following situations :
9750 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9751 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9752 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9753 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9754 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9755 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9756 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9757 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9758 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9759 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761
97627.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9763----------------------------------
9764
9765Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9766combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9767
9768 - AND (implicit)
9769 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9770 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009772A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009774 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009776Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9777indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009779For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9780"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9781requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9782is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9783
9784 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9785 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9786 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9787 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9788
9789To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9790and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9791
9792 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9793 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9794 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9795 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9796
9797 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9798 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9799 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9800 use_backend www if host_www
9801
9802It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9803expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9804be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9805the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9806
9807 The following rule :
9808
9809 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9810 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9811
9812 Can also be written that way :
9813
9814 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9815
9816It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9817to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9818simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9819sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9820good use is the following :
9821
9822 With named ACLs :
9823
9824 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9825 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9826 monitor fail if site_dead
9827
9828 With anonymous ACLs :
9829
9830 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9831
9832See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9833
9834
98357.3. Fetching samples
9836---------------------
9837
9838Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9839against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9840sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9841ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9842of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9843available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9844
9845This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9846Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9847compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9848deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9849
9850The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9851matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9852method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9853indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9854
9855As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9856when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9857mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9858the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9859ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9860
9861Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9862multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9863when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9864incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9865are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9866is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9867all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9868
9869Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9870 - name
9871 - name(arg1)
9872 - name(arg1,arg2)
9873
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009874
98757.3.1. Converters
9876-----------------
9877
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009878Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9879of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9880is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9881was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9882has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9883unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9884
9885These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9886sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9887the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9888support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009890The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009891
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009892base64
9893 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9894 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9895 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9896
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009897hex
9898 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9899 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9900 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9901 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009902
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009903http_date([<offset>])
9904 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9905 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9906 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9907 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9908 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9909 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009910
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009911ipmask(<mask>)
9912 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9913 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9914 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9915 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009917language(<value>[,<default>])
9918 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9919 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9920 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9921 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9922 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9923 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9924 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9925 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9926 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9927 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9928 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9929 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009931 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009932
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009933 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9934 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009935
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009936 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9937 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9938 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9939 use_backend spanish if es
9940 use_backend french if fr
9941 use_backend english if en
9942 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009943
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009944lower
9945 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9946 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9947 type. The result is of type string.
9948
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009949map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9950map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9951map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9952 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9953 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9954 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9955 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9956 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9957 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9958 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9959 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009960
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009961 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9962 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9963 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009964
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009965 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9966 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009968 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9969 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9970 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9971 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009972 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9973 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009974 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9975 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9976 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9977 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9978 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9979 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9980 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9981 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9982 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9983 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9984 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9985 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9986 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9987 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009988
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009989 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9990 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9991 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9992 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9993 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009995 Example :
9996
9997 # this is a comment and is ignored
9998 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9999 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10000 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10001 | | | `---------- value
10002 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10003 | `---------------------------- key
10004 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10005
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010006upper
10007 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10008 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10009 type. The result is of type string.
10010
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010011
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100127.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013--------------------------------------------
10014
10015A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10016not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10017"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10018The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10019
10020always_false : boolean
10021 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10022 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10023
10024always_true : boolean
10025 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10026 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10027
10028avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010029 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010030 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10031 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10032 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10033 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10034 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10035 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10036 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10037 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10038 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10039 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10040 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10041 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10042 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010045 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10046 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10047 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10048 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10049 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010051be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10052 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10053 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10054 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10055 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10056 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10057 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058
10059 Example :
10060 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10061 backend dynamic
10062 mode http
10063 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10064 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010068 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010069 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10070 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010071
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010072 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010073 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010074 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10075
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010076 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10077 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010078
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010079 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010080 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010082 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10083 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010085 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010086
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010087 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10088 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010089 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010090 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010091
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010092date([<offset>]) : integer
10093 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10094 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10095 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10096 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010097 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10098
10099 Example :
10100
10101 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10102 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010103
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010104env(<name>) : string
10105 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10106 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10107 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10108 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10109 certain way.
10110
10111 Examples :
10112 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10113 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10114
10115 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10116 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10119 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010120 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10121 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10123 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10124 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10125 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10126 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010128fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10129 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10130 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10131 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10132 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10133 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10134 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10135 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10136 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010137
10138 Example :
10139 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10140 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10141 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10142 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10143 frontend mail
10144 bind :25
10145 mode tcp
10146 maxconn 100
10147 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10148 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10149 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10150 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010152nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10153 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10154 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10155 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010156 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10157 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10158 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010160queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010161 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10162 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10163 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10165 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10166 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10167 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10168 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10169
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010170rand([<range>]) : integer
10171 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10172 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10173 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10174 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10175 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010177srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10178 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10179 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10180 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10181 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10182 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10183 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10184 methods.
10185
10186srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10187 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10188 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10189 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10190 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10191 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10192 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10193 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10194
10195srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10196 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10197 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010198 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010199 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10200 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10201 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10202 overloading servers).
10203
10204 Example :
10205 # Redirect to a separate back
10206 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10207 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10208 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10209
10210table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10211 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10212 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10213
10214table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10215 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10216 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10217 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10218
10219
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102207.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010221----------------------------------
10222
10223The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10224closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10225methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10226sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10227TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010228the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10229counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10230"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010231argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10232the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10233this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010234
10235be_id : integer
10236 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10237 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10238
10239dst : ip
10240 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10241 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10242 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10243 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10244 RFC 4291.
10245
10246dst_conn : integer
10247 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10248 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10249 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10250 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10251 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10252 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10253 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10254 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010256dst_port : integer
10257 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10258 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10259 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10260 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10261 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10262 an HTTP header.
10263
10264fe_id : integer
10265 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10266 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10267 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10268
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010269sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010270sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10271sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10272sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010273 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10274 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10275 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10276
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010277sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010278sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10279sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10280sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010281 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10282 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10283 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10284
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010285sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010286sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10287sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10288sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010289 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10290 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010291 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10292 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10293 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010294
10295 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10296 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010297 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10298 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10299 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010300 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10301 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010303sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010304sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10305sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10306sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010307 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10308 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010310sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010311sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10312sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10313sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010314 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10315 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10316 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10317
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010318sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010319sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10320sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10321sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010322 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10323 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10324 See also src_conn_rate.
10325
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010326sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010327sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10328sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10329sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010330 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010331 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010333sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010334sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10335sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10336sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010337 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10338 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10339 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010340 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10341 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10342 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010344sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010345sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10346sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10347sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010348 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10349 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10350 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010352sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010353sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10354sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10355sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010356 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10357 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10358 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10359 src_http_err_rate.
10360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010361sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010362sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10363sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10364sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010365 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10366 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10367 src_http_req_cnt.
10368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010369sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010370sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10371sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10372sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010373 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10374 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10375 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10376 src_http_req_rate.
10377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010378sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010379sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10380sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10381sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010382 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010383 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10384 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10385 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10386 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010387
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010388 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10389 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010390 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010392sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010393sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10394sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10395sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010396 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10397 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10398 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010400sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010401sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10402sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10403sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010404 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10405 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10406 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010408sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010409sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10410sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10411sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010412 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10413 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10414 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10415 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010416 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010417 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010419sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010420sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10421sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10422sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010423 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10424 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10425 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10426 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10427 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010428 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010429
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010430sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010431sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10432sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10433sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010434 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10435 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10436 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10437
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010438sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010439sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10440sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10441sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010442 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10443 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010444 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010445 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10446 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010447 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10448 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10449 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010451so_id : integer
10452 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10453 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10454 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456src : ip
10457 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10458 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10459 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10460 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10461 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10462 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10463 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010464
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010465 Example:
10466 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10467 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10470 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10471 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10472 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010473 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010475src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10476 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10477 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010478 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010479 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010481src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10482 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10483 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10484 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10485 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10486 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10487 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010488
10489 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10490 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10491 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10492 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010493 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010494 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10495 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010497src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010498 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010499 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010500 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010501 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010503src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010504 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010505 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10506 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010507 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010509src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10510 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10511 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10512 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010513 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010515src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010516 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010518 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010519 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010522 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010523 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010524 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10525 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010526 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10527 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10528 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010530src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10531 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10532 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010533 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010534 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010537src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10538 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10539 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10540 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10541 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010542 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10545 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10546 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10547 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010548 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010550src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10551 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10552 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10553 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010554 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010555 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10558 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10559 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10560 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010561 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10563 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010564
10565 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010566 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010567 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010570 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10571 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10572 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10573 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10574 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010577 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10578 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10579 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10580 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10581 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010583src_port : integer
10584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10585 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10586 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10587 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10590 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010591 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10592 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10593 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010594 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10597 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10598 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10599 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10600 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010601 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010603src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10604 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10605 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10606 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10607 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10608 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10609 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10610 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10611 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010612
10613 Example :
10614 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10615 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10616 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10617 listen ssh
10618 bind :22
10619 mode tcp
10620 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010621 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010623 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010625srv_id : integer
10626 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10627 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10628 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010629
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010630
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106317.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010632----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10635closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10636when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10637usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010638future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010639
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010640ssl_bc : boolean
10641 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10642 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10643 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10644
10645ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10646 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10647 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10648
10649ssl_bc_cipher : string
10650 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10651 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10652
10653ssl_bc_protocol : string
10654 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10655 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10656
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010657ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010658 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010659 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10660 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010661
10662ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10663 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10664 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10665 if session was reused or not.
10666
10667ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10668 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10669 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10672 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10673 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10674 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10675 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10676 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10679 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10680 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10681 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10682 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010683
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010684ssl_c_der : binary
10685 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10686 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10687 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010689ssl_c_err : integer
10690 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10691 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10692 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10693 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10694 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010696ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10697 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10698 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10699 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10700 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10701 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10702 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10703 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10704 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706ssl_c_key_alg : string
10707 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10708 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10709 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010711ssl_c_notafter : string
10712 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10713 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10714 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010716ssl_c_notbefore : string
10717 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10718 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10719 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10722 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10723 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10724 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10725 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10726 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10727 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10728 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10729 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010731ssl_c_serial : binary
10732 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10733 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10734 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010736ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10737 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10738 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10739 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010740 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10741 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10742
10743 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10746 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10747 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10748 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010750ssl_c_used : boolean
10751 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10752 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754ssl_c_verify : integer
10755 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10756 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10757 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10758 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010760ssl_c_version : integer
10761 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10762 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010763
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010764ssl_f_der : binary
10765 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10766 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10767 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10770 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10771 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10772 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10773 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010774 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10776 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10777 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010779ssl_f_key_alg : string
10780 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10781 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10782 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010784ssl_f_notafter : string
10785 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10786 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10787 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010789ssl_f_notbefore : string
10790 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10791 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10792 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010794ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10795 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10796 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10797 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10798 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10799 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10800 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10801 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10802 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010804ssl_f_serial : binary
10805 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10806 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10807 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010808
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010809ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10810 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10811 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10812 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010814ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10815 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10816 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10817 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819ssl_f_version : integer
10820 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10821 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10822
10823ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010824 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10825 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10826 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828 Example :
10829 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10830 listen http-https
10831 bind :80
10832 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10833 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10834
10835ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10836 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10837 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10838
10839ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010840 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010841 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10842 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10843 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10844 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10845 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10846 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10847 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10848 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850ssl_fc_cipher : string
10851 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10852 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010855 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10856 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010857 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10858 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10859 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10860 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010862ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10863 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010864 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10865 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10866 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10867 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010870 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10872 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10873 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10874 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10875 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10876 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10877 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879ssl_fc_protocol : string
10880 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10881 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010882
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010883ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010884 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010885 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10886 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10889 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10890 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10891 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10892 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010894ssl_fc_sni : string
10895 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10896 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10897 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10898 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10899 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10900
10901 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10902 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10903 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010904 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10905 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010908 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10909 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10912 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10913 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010914
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10920sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10921only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10922For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10923be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10924can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10925sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10926for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10927content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010929payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10930 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10931 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10932 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010934payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10935 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10936 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10937 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939req.len : integer
10940req_len : integer (deprecated)
10941 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10942 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10943 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10944 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10945 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10946 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10947 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10948 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010950req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10951 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010952 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10953 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10954 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10955 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957 ACL alternatives :
10958 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010960req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10961 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10962 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10963 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10964 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010966 ACL alternatives :
10967 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971req.proto_http : boolean
10972req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10973 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10974 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10975 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10976 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10977 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10978 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10979 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010981 Example:
10982 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10983 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10984 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010985 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010987req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10988rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10989 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10990 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10991 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10992 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10993 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10994 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10995 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10998 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10999 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11000 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11001 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11002 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004 ACL derivatives :
11005 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007 Example :
11008 listen tse-farm
11009 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11010 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11011 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11012 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11013 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11014 persist rdp-cookie
11015 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11016 # This is only useful makes sense if
11017 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11018 stick-table type string size 204800
11019 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11020 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11021 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11024 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11027rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11028 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11029 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11030 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11031 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011033 ACL derivatives :
11034 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011036req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11037req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11038 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11039 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11040 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11041 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11042 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11043 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11044 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046req.ssl_sni : string
11047req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11048 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11049 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11050 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11051 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11052 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11053 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11054 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11055 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11056 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11057 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11058 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11059 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011061 ACL derivatives :
11062 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064 Examples :
11065 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11066 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11067 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11068 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11069 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011071res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11072rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11073 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11074 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11075 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11076 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11077 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11078 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11079 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011081req.ssl_ver : integer
11082req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11083 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11084 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11085 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11086 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11087 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11088 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11089 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11090 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11091 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011093 ACL derivatives :
11094 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011095
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011096res.len : integer
11097 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11098 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11099 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11100 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11101 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11102 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11103 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11104 content inspection.
11105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11107 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011108 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11109 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11110 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11111 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011113res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11114 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11115 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11116 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11117 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011119 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011121wait_end : boolean
11122 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11123 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11124 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11125 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11126 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11127 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11128 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11129 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011131 Examples :
11132 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11133 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11134 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11137 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11138 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11139 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11140 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11141 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11142 tcp-request content reject
11143
11144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011146--------------------------------------
11147
11148It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11149This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11150data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11151its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11152HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11153content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11154to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11155more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11156response are indexed.
11157
11158base : string
11159 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11160 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11161 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11162 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11163 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11164 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11165 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11166 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11167
11168 ACL derivatives :
11169 base : exact string match
11170 base_beg : prefix match
11171 base_dir : subdir match
11172 base_dom : domain match
11173 base_end : suffix match
11174 base_len : length match
11175 base_reg : regex match
11176 base_sub : substring match
11177
11178base32 : integer
11179 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11180 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11181 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11182 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11183
11184base32+src : binary
11185 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11186 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11187 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11188 per-URL counters.
11189
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011190capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11191 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11192 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11193 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11194
11195capture.req.method : string
11196 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11197 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11198 because it's allocated.
11199
11200capture.req.uri : string
11201 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11202 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11203 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11204 allocated.
11205
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011206capture.req.ver : string
11207 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11208 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11209 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11210
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011211capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11212 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11213 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11214 The first entry is an index of 0.
11215 See also: "capture response header"
11216
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011217capture.res.ver : string
11218 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11219 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11220 persistent flag.
11221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011222req.cook([<name>]) : string
11223cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11224 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11225 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11226 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11227 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11228 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11229 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11230 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11231 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11232
11233 ACL derivatives :
11234 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11235 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11236 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11237 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11238 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11239 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11240 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11241 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011243req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11244cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11245 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11246 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011248req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11249cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11250 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11251 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11252 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11253 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011255cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11256 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11257 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11258 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11259 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11260 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11261 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11262 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11263 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11264 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11265 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011267hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11268 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11269 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11270 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11271 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011272 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011274req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11275 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11276 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11277 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11278 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11279 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11280 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11281 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11282 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011284req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11285 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11286 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11287 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11288 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11291 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11292 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11293 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11294 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11295 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11296 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11297 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11298 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11299 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11300 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11301 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011303 ACL derivatives :
11304 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11305 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11306 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11307 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11308 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11309 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11310 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11311 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11312
11313req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11314hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11315 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11316 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11317 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11318 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11319 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11320 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11321 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11322 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11323 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11324
11325req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11326hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11327 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11328 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11329 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11330 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11331 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11332 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11333 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11334 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11335
11336req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11337hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11338 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11339 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11340 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11341 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11342 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11343 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11344 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11345
11346http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11347 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11348 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11349 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11350 basic auth is supported.
11351
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011352http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11353 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11354 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11355 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11356 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011357 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11358 basic auth is supported.
11359
11360 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011361 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11362 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11363 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11364 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011365
11366http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011367 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11368 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11370 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011372method : integer + string
11373 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11374 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11375 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11376 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11377 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11378 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11379 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381 ACL derivatives :
11382 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011384 Example :
11385 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11386 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11387 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389path : string
11390 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11391 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11392 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11393 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11394 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11395 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11396 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011398 ACL derivatives :
11399 path : exact string match
11400 path_beg : prefix match
11401 path_dir : subdir match
11402 path_dom : domain match
11403 path_end : suffix match
11404 path_len : length match
11405 path_reg : regex match
11406 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408req.ver : string
11409req_ver : string (deprecated)
11410 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11411 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11412 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414 ACL derivatives :
11415 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011417res.comp : boolean
11418 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11419 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11420 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422res.comp_algo : string
11423 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11424 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11425 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011427res.cook([<name>]) : string
11428scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11429 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11430 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11431 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433 ACL derivatives :
11434 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011436res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11437scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11438 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11439 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11440 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11443scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11444 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11445 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11446 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011448res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11449 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11450 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11451 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11452 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11453 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11454 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11455 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11456 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11457 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11460 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11461 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11462 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11463 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11464 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011466res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11467shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11468 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11469 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11470 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11471 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11472 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11473 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11474 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11475 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011477 ACL derivatives :
11478 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11479 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11480 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11481 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11482 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11483 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11484 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11485 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11486
11487res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11488shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11489 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11490 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11491 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11492 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11493 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011495res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11496shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11497 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11498 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11499 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11500 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11501 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11502 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11505shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11506 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11507 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11508 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11509 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11510 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11511 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513res.ver : string
11514resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11515 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11516 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011518 ACL derivatives :
11519 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11522 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11523 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11524 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11525 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11528 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011530 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532status : integer
11533 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11534 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11535 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011537url : string
11538 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11539 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11540 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11541 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11542 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11543 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11544 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546 ACL derivatives :
11547 url : exact string match
11548 url_beg : prefix match
11549 url_dir : subdir match
11550 url_dom : domain match
11551 url_end : suffix match
11552 url_len : length match
11553 url_reg : regex match
11554 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011556url_ip : ip
11557 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11558 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11559 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11560 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11561 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11562 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11563 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565url_port : integer
11566 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11567 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11568 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11569 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11572url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11573 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11574 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11575 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11576 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11577 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11578 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11579 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11580 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11581 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011583 ACL derivatives :
11584 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11585 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11586 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11587 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11588 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11589 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11590 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11591 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011592
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594 Example :
11595 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11596 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11597 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11598 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011600urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11601 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11602 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11603 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011604
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116067.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011607---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011609Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11610every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011611order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011613ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11614---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011615FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011616HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011617HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11618HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011619HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11620HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11621HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11622HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11623LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11625METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11626METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11627METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11628METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11629METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011630RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011631REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011632TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011633WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11634---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011635
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116378. Logging
11638----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011640One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11641provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11642very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11643provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11644state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011645to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011646headers.
11647
11648In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11649about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11650send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11651
11652 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11653 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11654 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11655 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11656 at the termination.
11657
11658The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11659allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11660as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11661while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11662real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11663delay.
11664
11665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116668.1. Log levels
11667---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011668
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011669TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011670source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011671HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11672in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11673track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11674syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11675about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011676
11677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116788.2. Log formats
11679----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011680
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011681HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011682and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11683slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11684options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011685
11686 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11687 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11688 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11689 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11690 extents.
11691
11692 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11693 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11694 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11695 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11696 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11697
11698 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11699 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11700 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11701 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11702 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11703
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011704 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11705 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11706 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11707 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11708
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011709 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011711Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11712specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11713field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11714servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11715always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11716identifier.
11717
11718Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11719 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11720 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11721 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11722 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11723
11724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117258.2.1. Default log format
11726-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011727
11728This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11729as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11730format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11731
11732 Example :
11733 listen www
11734 mode http
11735 log global
11736 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11737
11738 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11739 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11740 (www/HTTP)
11741
11742 Field Format Extract from the example above
11743 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11744 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11745 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11746 4 'to' to
11747 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11748 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11749
11750Detailed fields description :
11751 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11752 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11753 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11754 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11755 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11756 and processed the connection.
11757 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11758
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011759In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11760"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11761connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11762
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011763It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11764will eventually disappear.
11765
11766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117678.2.2. TCP log format
11768---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011769
11770The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11771is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11772information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11773counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11774emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11775environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11776the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11777sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011778specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11779not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11780fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11781marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011782
11783 Example :
11784 frontend fnt
11785 mode tcp
11786 option tcplog
11787 log global
11788 default_backend bck
11789
11790 backend bck
11791 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11792
11793 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11794 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11795 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11796
11797 Field Format Extract from the example above
11798 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11799 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11800 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11801 4 frontend_name fnt
11802 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11803 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11804 7 bytes_read* 212
11805 8 termination_state --
11806 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11807 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11808
11809Detailed fields description :
11810 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011811 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11812 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11813 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11814 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11815 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011816
11817 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011818 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11819 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11820 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011821
11822 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11823 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11824 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11825 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11826
11827 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11828 and processed the connection.
11829
11830 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11831 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11832 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11833 applications.
11834
11835 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11836 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11837 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11838 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11839 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11840
11841 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11842 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11843 See "Timers" below for more details.
11844
11845 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11846 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11847 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11848 "Timers" below for more details.
11849
11850 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011851 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011852 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11853 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11854 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11855 details.
11856
11857 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11858 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11859 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11860 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11861 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11862
11863 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11864 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11865 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11866 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11867 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11868 for more details.
11869
11870 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011871 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11873 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11874 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011875 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011876
11877 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11878 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11879 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11880 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11881 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11882 caused by a denial of service attack.
11883
11884 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11885 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11886 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11887 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11888 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11889 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11890 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11891 denial of service attack.
11892
11893 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11894 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11895 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11896 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11897 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11898 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11899 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11900 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11901 be processed than on other servers.
11902
11903 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11904 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11905 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11906 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11907 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11908 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11909 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11910 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11911 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11912 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11913 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11914 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11915 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11916
11917 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11918 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11919 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11920 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11921 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11922 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11923 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11924 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11925
11926 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11927 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11928 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11929 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11930 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11931 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11932 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11933 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11934 occurs.
11935
11936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119378.2.3. HTTP log format
11938----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011939
11940The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11941is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11942the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11943are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11944emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11945generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11946"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11947which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011948frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11949is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011950
11951Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11952slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11953with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11954
11955 Example :
11956 frontend http-in
11957 mode http
11958 option httplog
11959 log global
11960 default_backend bck
11961
11962 backend static
11963 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11964
11965 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11966 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11967 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011968 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011969
11970 Field Format Extract from the example above
11971 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11972 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11973 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11974 4 frontend_name http-in
11975 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11976 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11977 7 status_code 200
11978 8 bytes_read* 2750
11979 9 captured_request_cookie -
11980 10 captured_response_cookie -
11981 11 termination_state ----
11982 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11983 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11984 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11985 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11986 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011987
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011988
11989Detailed fields description :
11990 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011991 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11992 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11993 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11994 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11995 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011996
11997 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011998 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11999 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12000 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012001
12002 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12003 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12004 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12005 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12006 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12007
12008 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12009 and processed the connection.
12010
12011 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12012 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12013 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12014
12015 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12016 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12017 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12018 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12019 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12020 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12021
12022 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12023 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12024 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12025 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12026 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12027 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12028
12029 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12030 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12031 See "Timers" below for more details.
12032
12033 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12034 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12035 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12036 below for more details.
12037
12038 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12039 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12040 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12041 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12042 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12043 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12044 for more details.
12045
12046 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012047 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012048 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12049 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12050 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12051 details.
12052
12053 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12054 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12055 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12056
12057 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12058 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12059 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12060 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12061 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12062 overflowing.
12063
12064 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12065 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12066 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12067 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12068 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12069 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12070 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12071 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12072
12073 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12074 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12075 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12076 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12077 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12078 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12079 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12080 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12081
12082 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12083 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12084 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12085 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12086 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12087 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12088 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12089
12090 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012091 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012092 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12093 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12094 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012095 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012096 system.
12097
12098 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12099 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12100 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12101 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12102 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12103 caused by a denial of service attack.
12104
12105 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12106 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12107 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12108 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12109 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12110 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12111 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12112 denial of service attack.
12113
12114 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12115 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12116 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12117 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12118 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12119 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12120 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12121 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12122 processed than on other servers.
12123
12124 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12125 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12126 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12127 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12128 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12129 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12130 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12131 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12132 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12133 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12134 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12135 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12136 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12137
12138 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12139 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12140 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12141 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12142 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12143 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12144 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12145 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12146
12147 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12148 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12149 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12150 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12151 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12152 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12153 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12154 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12155 occurs.
12156
12157 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12158 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12159 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12160 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12161 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12162 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12163 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12164 cookies" below for more details.
12165
12166 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12167 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12168 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12169 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12170 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12171 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12172 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12173 and cookies" below for more details.
12174
12175 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12176 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12177 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12178 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12179 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12180 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12181 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12182 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12183
12184
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200121858.2.4. Custom log format
12186------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012187
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012188The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012189mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012190
12191HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12192Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12193separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12194prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12195
12196Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12197variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12198string formats ("Q").
12199
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012200If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012201as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012202less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12203the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12204
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012205Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012206In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012207in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012208
12209Flags are :
12210 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012211 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012212
12213 Example:
12214
12215 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12216 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12217
12218At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12219
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012220 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12221 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012222
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012223the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012224
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012225 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012226 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012227 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012228
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012229and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12230
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012231 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012232 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12233
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012234Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12235
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012236 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012237 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012238 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12239 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12240 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012241 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12242 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12243 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012244 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012245 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012246 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012247 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012248 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012249 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012250 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12251 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012252 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012253 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12254 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012255 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012256 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12257 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012258 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12259 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12260 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012261 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012262 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12263 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012264 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012265 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12266 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12267 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012268 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012269 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12270 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12271 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12272 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012273 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012274 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012275 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012276 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012277 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012278 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012279 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12280 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12281 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012282 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012283 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12284 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012285 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012286 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012287 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012288 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012289
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012290 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012291
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012292
122938.2.5. Error log format
12294-----------------------
12295
12296When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12297protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12298By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12299"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12300will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12301logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12302
12303The format looks like this :
12304
12305 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12306 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12307 Connection error during SSL handshake
12308
12309 Field Format Extract from the example above
12310 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12311 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12312 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12313 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12314 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12315
12316These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12317failures.
12318
12319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123208.3. Advanced logging options
12321-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012322
12323Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12324just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12325options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12326for more information about their usage.
12327
12328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123298.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12330------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012331
12332It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12333haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12334commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12335monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12336ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12337
12338 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12339 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12340 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12341 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12342
12343 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12344 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12345 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012346 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012347 such as other load-balancers.
12348
12349 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12350 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12351 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12352
12353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123548.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12355----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012356
12357The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12358what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12359or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12360"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12361just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12362log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12363after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12364is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12365with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12366with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12367
12368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123698.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12370------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012371
12372Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12373for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12374"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12375retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12376raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12377a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12378file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12379you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12380"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12381
12382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12384--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012385
12386Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12387multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12388them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12389"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12390logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12391error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12392and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12393too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12394useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12395alternative.
12396
12397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123988.4. Timing events
12399------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012400
12401Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12402reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12403the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12404frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12405mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12406
12407 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12408 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12409 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12410 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12411 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12412
12413 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12414 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12415 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12416 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12417 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12418
12419 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12420 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12421 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12422 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12423 connection never established.
12424
12425 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12426 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12427 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12428 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12429 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12430 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12431 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12432 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12433 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12434 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12435 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12436
12437 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12438 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12439 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12440 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012441 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012442
12443 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12444
12445 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12446 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12447 negative.
12448
12449These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12450protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12451that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012452due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012453close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12454session has been aborted on timeout.
12455
12456Most common cases :
12457
12458 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12459 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12460 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12461 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12462 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12463 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12464 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12465 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12466 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012467 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12468 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12469 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012470
12471 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12472 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12473 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12474 of ms on remote networks.
12475
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012476 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12477 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12478 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012479
12480 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12481 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12482 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12483 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12484 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12485 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12486 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12487 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12488 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12489 to the server until another one is released.
12490
12491Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12492
12493 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12494 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12495 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12496
12497 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12498 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12499 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12500
12501 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12502 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12503 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12504 flags.
12505
12506 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12507 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12508 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12509 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12510 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12511 the client connection was maintained open.
12512
12513 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012514 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012515 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12516 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12517
12518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125198.5. Session state at disconnection
12520-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012521
12522TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12523"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125242-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12525each of which has a special meaning :
12526
12527 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12528 session to terminate :
12529
12530 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12531
12532 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12533 server explicitly refused it.
12534
12535 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12536 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12537 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12538 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012539 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12540
12541 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12542 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012543
12544 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12545 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12546 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12547 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12548 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12549
12550 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12551 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12552 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12553 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12554 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12555
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012556 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12557 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12558
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012559 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12560 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12561 backup connections when going up.
12562
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012563 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12564
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012565 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12566 send or receive data.
12567
12568 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12569 send or receive data.
12570
12571 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12572 with nothing left in the buffers.
12573
12574 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12575
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012576 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012577 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12578
12579 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12580 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12581 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12582 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12583 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12584
12585 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12586 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12587
12588 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12589 server (HTTP only).
12590
12591 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12592
12593 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12594 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12595 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12596
12597 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12598 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12599 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12600
12601 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12602
12603 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12604 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12605
12606 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12607 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12608 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12609
12610 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12611 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012612 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12613 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012614
12615 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12616 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12617 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12618 another server.
12619
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012620 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012621 server.
12622
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012623 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12624 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12625 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12626 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12627
12628 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12629 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12630 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12631 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12632
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012633 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12634 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12635 "use-server" rule).
12636
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012637 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12638
12639 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12640 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12641
12642 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12643
12644 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12645 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12646 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12647
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012648 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12649 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012650 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012651 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12652 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12653
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012654 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12655
12656 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12657 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12658
12659 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12660
12661 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12662
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012663The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12664was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012665helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12666starvation, attacks, etc...
12667
12668The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12669alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12670easier finding and understanding.
12671
12672 Flags Reason
12673
12674 -- Normal termination.
12675
12676 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12677 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12678 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12679 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12680
12681 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12682 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12683 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12684 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12685 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12686 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012688 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12689 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012690 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012691
12692 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12693 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12694 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12695
12696 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12697 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12698 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12699 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12700 the server takes too long to respond.
12701
12702 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12703 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12704 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12705 long a time to respond.
12706
12707 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12708 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12709 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12710 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12711 and the client.
12712
12713 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12714 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12715 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12716 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12717 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012718 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12719 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12720 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12721 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12722 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12723 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12724 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12725 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12726 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12727 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12728 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12729 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12730 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12731 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012732
12733 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12734 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012735 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12736 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12737 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12738 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012739
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012740 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12741 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012743 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012744 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12745 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12746 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12747 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12748 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12749
12750 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12751 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12752 503 or 504 here.
12753
12754 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12755 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12756 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12757 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12758 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12759
12760 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12761 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012762 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012763 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12764 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12765
12766 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12767 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12768 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12769 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12770 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12771 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12772 between haproxy and the server.
12773
12774 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12775 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12776 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12777 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12778 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12779 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12780 solution is to fix the application.
12781
12782 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12783 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12784 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12785 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12786 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12787 external attacks.
12788
12789 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12790 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012791 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012792 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12793 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12794
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012795 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12796 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12797 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012798 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12799 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012801 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12802 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12803 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12804 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012805 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12806 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12807 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12808 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12809 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012810
12811 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12812 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12813 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12814 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12815
12816 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12817 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12818 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12819 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12820
12821 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12822 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12823 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12824 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12825
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012826The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12827persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12828important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12829re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12830
12831 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12832
12833 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12834 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12835 set on a GET request.
12836
12837 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12838 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012839 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012840 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12841
12842 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12843 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12844 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12845
12846 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12847 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12848 already got a cookie.
12849
12850 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12851 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12852 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12853 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12854 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12855
12856 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12857 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12858 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12859
12860 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12861 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12862 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12863
12864 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12865 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12866
12867 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12868 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12869 then advertised in the response.
12870
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128728.6. Non-printable characters
12873-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012874
12875In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12876consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12877converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12878prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12879being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12880escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12881is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12882'}' when logging headers.
12883
12884Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12885issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12886containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12887
12888Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12889the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12890performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12891
12892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128938.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12894---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012895
12896Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12897achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012898section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012899cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12900the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12901the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012902locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012903not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12904user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12905a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12906wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12907
12908 Examples :
12909 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12910 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12911
12912 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12913 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12914
12915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129168.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12917---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012918
12919Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12920proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12921the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12922server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12923
12924Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12925response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012926section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012927
12928It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012929time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12930appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012931are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12932and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12933follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12934request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12935in the logs.
12936
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012937As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12938frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12939an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12940
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012941 Example :
12942 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12943 listen proxy-out
12944 mode http
12945 option httplog
12946 option logasap
12947 log global
12948 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12949
12950 # log the name of the virtual server
12951 capture request header Host len 20
12952
12953 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12954 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12955
12956 # log the beginning of the referrer
12957 capture request header Referer len 20
12958
12959 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12960 capture response header Server len 20
12961
12962 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12963 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12964
12965 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12966 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12967
12968 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12969 capture response header Via len 20
12970
12971 # log the URL location during a redirection
12972 capture response header Location len 20
12973
12974 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12975 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12976 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12977 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12978 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12979
12980 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12981 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12982 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12983 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012984 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012985
12986 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12987 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12988 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12989 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12990 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012991 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992
12993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129948.9. Examples of logs
12995---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012996
12997These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12998them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12999reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13000
13001 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13002 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13003 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13004
13005 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13006 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13007
13008 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13009 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13010 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13011
13012 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13013 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13014
13015 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13016 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13017 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13018
13019 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013020 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013021 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13022 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13023
13024 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13025 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13026 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13027
13028 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13029 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013030 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013031 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13032 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13033 to return the 502 and not the server.
13034
13035 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013036 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013037
13038 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13039 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13040 Nothing was sent to any server.
13041
13042 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13043 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13044
13045 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13046 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13047 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13048 send a 408 return code to the client.
13049
13050 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13051 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13052
13053 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13054 5 seconds ("c----").
13055
13056 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13057 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013058 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013059
13060 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013061 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013062 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13063 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13064 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13065 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13066 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013067
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130699. Statistics and monitoring
13070----------------------------
13071
13072It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13073mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13074CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13075Unix socket.
13076
13077
130789.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013079---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013080
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013081The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013082page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13083begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13084represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13085use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13086('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13087(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13088text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13089do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13090use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013091
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013092In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13093that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13094S (Servers).
13095
13096 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13097 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13098 any name for server/listener)
13099 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13100 number queued without a server assigned.
13101 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13102 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13103 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13104 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13105 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13106 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13107 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13108 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13109 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13110 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13111 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13112 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13113 "option checkcache".
13114 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13115 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13116 - read error from the client
13117 - client timeout
13118 - client closed connection
13119 - various bad requests from the client.
13120 - request was tarpitted.
13121 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13122 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13123 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13124 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13125 active servers).
13126 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13127 Some other errors are:
13128 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13129 - failure applying filters to the response.
13130 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13131 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13132 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13133 switched away from.
13134 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13135 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13136 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13137 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13138 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13139 the server is up.)
13140 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13141 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13142 counters for each server.
13143 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13144 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13145 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13146 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13147 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13148 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13149 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13150 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13151 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13152 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13153 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13154 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13155 of times that server was selected.
13156 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13157 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13158 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13159 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13160 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13161 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013162 UNK -> unknown
13163 INI -> initializing
13164 SOCKERR -> socket error
13165 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13166 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13167 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13168 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13169 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13170 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13171 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13172 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13173 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13174 disable-on-404
13175 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13176 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13177 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013178 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13179 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13180 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13181 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13182 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13183 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13184 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13185 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13186 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13187 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13188 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13189 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13190 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13191 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13192 (inc. in eresp)
13193 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13194 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13195 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13196 (CPU/BW limit)
13197 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13198 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13199 server/backend
13200 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13201 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13202 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13203 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13204 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13205 (0 for TCP)
13206 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13207 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013208
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132109.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013211-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013212
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013213The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13214necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13215A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13216issuing commands by hand :
13217
13218 global
13219 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13220 stats timeout 2m
13221
13222It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13223the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13224never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13225situations :
13226
13227 global
13228 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13229 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13230 stats timeout 2m
13231
13232To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13233swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13234to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13235syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13236
13237 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13238 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13239
13240The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13241script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13242for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13243
13244The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13245that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13246editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13247(eg: watch a counter).
13248
13249The socket supports two operation modes :
13250 - interactive
13251 - non-interactive
13252
13253The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13254this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13255sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13256mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13257commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13258example :
13259
13260 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13261
13262The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13263entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13264for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13265sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13266"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13267after processing the last command of the same line.
13268
13269For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13270"prompt" command :
13271
13272 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13273 prompt
13274 > show info
13275 ...
13276 >
13277
13278Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13279delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13280that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13281parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013282
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013283It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13284on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13285own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013286
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013287The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13288If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13289all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13290it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13291
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013292add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013293 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13294 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13295 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13296 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013297
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013298add map <map> <key> <value>
13299 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13300 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013301 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13302 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13303 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013305clear counters
13306 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13307 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13308 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13309 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13310 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13311
13312clear counters all
13313 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13314 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13315 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13316
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013317clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013318 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13319 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13320 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013321
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013322clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013323 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13324 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13325 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013326
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013327clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13328 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13329
13330 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13331 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13332 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13333 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13334 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13335 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13336
13337 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13338
13339 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13340 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13341 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13342 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13343 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13344 the ACLs :
13345
13346 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13347 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13348 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13349 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13350 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13351 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13352
13353 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013354 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13355 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013356
13357 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013358 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013359 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013360 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13361 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13362 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13363 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013364
13365 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13366
13367 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013368 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013369 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13370 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013371 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13372 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13373 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013374
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013375del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13376 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013377 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13378 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13379 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13380 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013381
13382del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013383 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013384 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13385 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13386 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13387 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013388
13389disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013390 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13391
13392 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13393 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13394 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13395 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13396 re-enabled using enable agent.
13397
13398 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13399 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13400 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13401 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13402 otherwise unchanged.
13403
13404 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13405 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13406 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13407
13408 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13409 level "admin".
13410
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013411disable frontend <frontend>
13412 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13413 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13414 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13415 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13416 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13417 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13418 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13419 on the stats page.
13420
13421 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13422 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13423
13424 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13425 level "admin".
13426
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013427disable health <backend>/<server>
13428 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13429 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13430 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13431 agent check forces it down.
13432
13433 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13434 level "admin".
13435
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013436disable server <backend>/<server>
13437 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13438 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13439 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13440 during the maintenance.
13441
13442 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13443 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13444
13445 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013446 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013447
13448 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13449 level "admin".
13450
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013451enable agent <backend>/<server>
13452 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13453
13454 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13455 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13456
13457 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13458 level "admin".
13459
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013460enable frontend <frontend>
13461 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13462 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13463 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13464 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13465 which was disabled.
13466
13467 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13468 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13469
13470 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13471 level "admin".
13472
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013473enable health <backend>/<server>
13474 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13475 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13476
13477 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13478 level "admin".
13479
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013480enable server <backend>/<server>
13481 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13482 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13483
13484 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013485 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013486
13487 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13488 level "admin".
13489
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013490get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013491get acl <acl> <value>
13492 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13493 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13494 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13495 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13496 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013497
13498 The first two words are:
13499
13500 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13501 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13502 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13503
13504 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13505
13506 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13507
13508 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13509
13510 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13511 interpretation of the case.
13512
13513 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13514 useful with regular expressions.
13515
13516 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13517 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13518
13519 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13520 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13521 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13522
13523 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13524
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013525get weight <backend>/<server>
13526 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13527 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13528 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13529 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13530 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013531 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013532
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013533help
13534 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13535 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013536
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013537prompt
13538 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13539 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13540 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13541 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13542 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13543 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13544 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13545 command.
13546
13547quit
13548 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013549
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013550set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013551 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13552 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13553 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013554
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013555set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013556 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13557 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13558 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13559 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13560 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013561 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13562 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13563
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013564set maxconn global <maxconn>
13565 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13566 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13567 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13568 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13569 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13570 setting.
13571
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013572set rate-limit connections global <value>
13573 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13574 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13575 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13576 is passed in number of connections per second.
13577
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013578set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13579 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13580 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013581 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13582 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013583
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013584set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13585 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13586 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13587 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13588 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13589
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013590set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13591 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13592 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13593 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13594 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13595 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13596
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013597set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13598 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13599 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13600 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13601
13602set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13603 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13604 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13605 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13606
13607set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13608 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13609 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13610 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13611 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13612 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13613 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13614 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13615 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13616
13617set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13618 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13619 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13620
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013621set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13622 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13623 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13624 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13625 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13626
13627 Example:
13628 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13629 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13630 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13631 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13632
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013633set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013634 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13635 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13636 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13637 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013638 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13639 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013640
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013641set timeout cli <delay>
13642 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13643 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13644 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13645
13646set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13647 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13648 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013649 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13650 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13651 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13652 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13653 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13654 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13655 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13656 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13657 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13658 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13659 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13660 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13661 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013662
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013663show errors [<iid>]
13664 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13665 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013666 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13667 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13668 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013669
13670 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13671 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13672 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13673 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13674 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13675 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13676 are reported too.
13677
13678 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13679 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13680 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13681 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13682 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13683 code.
13684
13685 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13686 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13687 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13688 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13689 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13690 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13691 line.
13692
13693 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013694 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13695 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013696 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13697 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13698
13699 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13700 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13701 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13702 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13703 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13704 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13705 00204+ minal\r\n
13706 00211 \r\n
13707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013708 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013709 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13710 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13711 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13712 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13713 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13714 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013715
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013716show info
13717 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13718
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013719show map [<map>]
13720 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013721 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13722 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13723 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13724 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13725 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13726 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013727
13728show acl [<acl>]
13729 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013730 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13731 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13732 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13733 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13734 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013735
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013736show pools
13737 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13738 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13739 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13740 the pools.
13741
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013742show sess
13743 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013744 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13745 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13746
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013747show sess <id>
13748 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13749 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13750 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13751 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13752 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013753 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13754 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13755
13756 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13757 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013758
13759show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13760 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13761 possible to dump only selected items :
13762 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13763 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13764 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13765 for example:
13766 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13767 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13768 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13769
13770 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013771 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13772 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013773 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13774 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13775 Nbproc: 1
13776 Process_num: 1
13777 (...)
13778
13779 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13780 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13781 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13782 (...)
13783 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13784
13785 $
13786
13787 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13788 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13789 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13790 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013791 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013792
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013793show table
13794 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13795 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13796 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13797 entries currently in use.
13798
13799 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013800 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013801 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13802 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013803
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013804show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013805 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13806 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13807 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013808 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13809
13810 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13811 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13812 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13813 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13814 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13815
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013816 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13817 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13818 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13819 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13820 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13821 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13822
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013823
13824 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013825 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13826 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013827
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013828 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013829 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013830 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013831 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13832 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13833 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13834 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013835
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013836 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013837 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013838 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13839 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013840
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013841 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13842 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013843 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013844 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13845 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013846
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013847 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13848 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013849 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013850 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13851 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13852
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013853 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13854 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13855 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13856 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13857 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13858
13859 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13860 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13861 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013862 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13863 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013864 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13865 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013866
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013867shutdown frontend <frontend>
13868 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13869 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13870 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13871 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13872 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13873 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13874 once it is terminated.
13875
13876 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13877 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13878
13879 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13880 level "admin".
13881
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013882shutdown session <id>
13883 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13884 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13885 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13886 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13887 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13888 flag in the logs.
13889
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013890shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013891 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13892 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13893 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13894 'K' flag in the logs.
13895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013896/*
13897 * Local variables:
13898 * fill-column: 79
13899 * End:
13900 */